adiv6: add dap flags -adiv5 and -adiv6
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{am335xgpio}
588 @* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
589
590 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
591 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
592 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
593
594 @item @b{vdebug}
595 @* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
596 It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
597 with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The current version
598 supports only JTAG as a transport, but other virtual transports, like DAP are planned.
599
600 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
601 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
602 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
603 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
604 emulation model of target hardware.
605
606 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
607 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
608
609 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
610 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
611
612 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
613 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
614 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
615
616 @end itemize
617
618 @node About Jim-Tcl
619 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
620 @cindex Jim-Tcl
621 @cindex tcl
622
623 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
624 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
625 command interpreter.
626
627 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
628 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
629 much of anything about Tcl.
630 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
631
632 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
633 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
634 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
635 OpenOCD mailing list.
636
637 @itemize @bullet
638 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
639 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
640 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
641 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
642 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
643 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
644
645 @item @b{Missing Features}
646 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
647 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
648 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
649 enabled in OpenOCD.
650
651 @item @b{Scripts}
652 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
653 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
654 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
655
656 @item @b{Commands}
657 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
658 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
659 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
660 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
661
662 @item @b{Historical Note}
663 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
664 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
665 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
666 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
667
668 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
669 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
670 @end itemize
671
672 @node Running
673 @chapter Running
674 @cindex command line options
675 @cindex logfile
676 @cindex directory search
677
678 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
679 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
680 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
681 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
682 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
683 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
684 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
685
686 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
687 tell it how each debug session should work.
688 The @option{--help} option shows:
689 @verbatim
690 bash$ openocd --help
691
692 --help | -h display this help
693 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
694 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
695 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
696 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
697 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
698 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
699 --command | -c run <command>
700 @end verbatim
701
702 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
703 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
704 To specify one or more different
705 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
706
707 @example
708 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
709 @end example
710
711 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
712 @enumerate
713 @item the current directory,
714 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
715 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
716 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
717 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
718 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
719 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
720 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
721 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
722 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
723 @end enumerate
724 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
725
726 @quotation Note
727 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
728 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
729 @end quotation
730
731 @section Simple setup, no customization
732
733 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
734 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
735 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
736 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
737 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
738
739 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
740 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
741 the server with some variation of one of the following:
742
743 @example
744 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
745 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
746 @end example
747
748 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
749 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
750 If all goes well you'll see output something like
751
752 @example
753 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
754 For bug reports, read
755 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
756 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
757 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
758 @end example
759
760 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
761 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
762 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
763
764 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
765
766 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
767 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
768 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
769 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
770 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
771 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
772 ensure that this always succeeds.
773 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
774 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
775 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
776 and then shut down without acting as a server.
777
778 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
779 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
780 those channels.
781
782 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
783 the @option{-d} option.
784
785 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
786 @option{-c} command line switch.
787
788 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
789 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
790 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
791 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
792 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
793 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
794 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
795
796 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
797 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
798
799 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
800 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
801 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
802 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
803
804 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
805 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
806
807 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
808 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
809 and start the OpenOCD server.
810 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
811 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
812 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
813 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
814
815 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
816
817 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
818 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
819 and a USB cable on the other.
820 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
821 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
822
823 @enumerate
824 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
825 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
826 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
827 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
828 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
829 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
830 debugging host.
831
832 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
833 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
834 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
835 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
836 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
837
838 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
839 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
840 with 1.2 Volt boards.
841
842 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
843 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
844 ways to connect the cable.
845 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
846 Be sure it's firmly connected.
847
848 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
849 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
850 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
851 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
852 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
853 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
854 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
855 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
856
857 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
858 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
859 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
860 but are tedious to set up.
861 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
862 adapter signals to the right board pins.
863
864 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
865 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
866 you are using to run OpenOCD.
867 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
868
869 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
870 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
871 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
872 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
873
874 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
875 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
876 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
877
878 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
879 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
880 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
881 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
882
883 @end enumerate
884
885 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
886 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
887 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
888
889 @section Project Directory
890
891 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
892
893 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
894 single directory for your work with a given board.
895 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
896 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
897 files accessed through semihosting,
898 and for code you upload to the target board.
899 It is also the natural place to write files,
900 such as log files and data you download from the board.
901
902 @section Configuration Basics
903
904 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
905 a variety of ways you can mix them.
906 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
907
908 @itemize
909 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
910 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
911 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
912 @end itemize
913
914 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
915 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
916 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
917
918 @example
919 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
920
921 # GDB can also flash my flash!
922 gdb_memory_map enable
923 gdb_flash_program enable
924
925 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
926 @end example
927
928 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
929
930 @example
931 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
932 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
933 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
934 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
935 @end example
936
937 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
938 each supporting a different development task.
939 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
940 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
941
942 @quotation Important
943 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
944 problems with how it treats variables.
945 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
946 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
947 that can be tested in a later script.
948 @end quotation
949
950 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
951 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
952 to simplify your work.
953
954 @section User Config Files
955 @cindex config file, user
956 @cindex user config file
957 @cindex config file, overview
958
959 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
960 in one place.
961 One of the following will match your situation best:
962
963 @itemize
964 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
965 provided by someone else.
966 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
967 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
968 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
969 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
970 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
971 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
972
973 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
974 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
975
976 @enumerate
977 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
978 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
979 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
980 @end enumerate
981
982 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
983 The first is an interface config file.
984 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
985 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
986 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
987 meet your deadline:
988
989 @example
990 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
991 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
992 @end example
993
994 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
995 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
996 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
997 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
998
999 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1000 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1001 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1002 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1003 target and board
1004 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1005 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1006
1007 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1008 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1009 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1010 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1011
1012 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1013 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1014 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1015 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1016 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1017
1018 @quotation Note
1019 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1020 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1021 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1022 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1023 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1024 @end quotation
1025
1026 @item
1027 You may need to write some C code.
1028 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1029 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1030 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1031 a new chip architecture.
1032 @end itemize
1033
1034 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1035 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1036 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1037
1038 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1039 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1040 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1041 @itemize
1042
1043 @item
1044 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1045 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1046 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1047 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1048
1049 @item
1050 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1051 @cindex vector_catch
1052 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1053 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1054 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1055 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1056 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1057 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1058
1059 @item
1060 You might need to override some defaults.
1061 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1062 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1063
1064 @item
1065 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1066 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1067 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1068 @end itemize
1069
1070 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1071
1072 A few project-specific utility
1073 routines may well speed up your work.
1074 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1075
1076 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1077 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1078 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1079 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1080 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1081 may help:
1082
1083 @example
1084 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1085 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1086 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1087 # Leave the CPU halted.
1088 reset init
1089
1090 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1091 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1092
1093 # Start running.
1094 resume 0x20000000
1095 @}
1096 @end example
1097
1098 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1099 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1100 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1101 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1102 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1103
1104 @example
1105 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1106 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1107 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1108 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1109 reset init
1110
1111 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1112 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1113 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1114 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1115 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1116 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1117 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1118
1119 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1120 reset run
1121 @}
1122 @end example
1123
1124 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1125 from NAND.
1126 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1127 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1128 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1129
1130 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1131 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1132
1133 @section Target Software Changes
1134
1135 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1136 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1137 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1138 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1139 handling issues like:
1140
1141 @itemize @bullet
1142
1143 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1144 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1145 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1146 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1147 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1148 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1149 your debug sessions.
1150
1151 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1152 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1153 That might however be your only option.
1154
1155 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1156 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1157 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1158 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1159 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1160 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1161 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1162 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1163 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1164 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1165 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1166 instead of the whole thing.
1167 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1168 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1169
1170 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1171 @cindex ARM semihosting
1172 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1173 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1174 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1175 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1176 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1177 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1178 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1179 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1180 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1181 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1182 NAND or SPI flash.
1183
1184 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1185 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1186 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1187 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1188 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1189
1190 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1191 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1192 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1193 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1194 registers which can be used to change various features including
1195 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1196 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1197 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1198 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1199 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1200
1201 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1202 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1203 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1204 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1205 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1206
1207 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1208 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1209 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1210 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1211 early code execution can be debugged
1212 or firmware can be replaced.
1213
1214 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1215 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1216 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1217 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1218 operations like writing to memory.)
1219
1220 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1221 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1222 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1223 various kinds of message.
1224 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1225
1226 @end itemize
1227
1228 @section Target Hardware Setup
1229
1230 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1231 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1232 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1233 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1234 working with.}
1235
1236 Common issues include:
1237
1238 @itemize @bullet
1239
1240 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1241 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1242 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1243 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1244 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1245 or one from a daughtercard).
1246 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1247 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1248
1249 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1250 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1251 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1252 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1253 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1254 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1255
1256 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1257 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1258 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1259 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1260 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1261
1262
1263 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1264 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1265 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1266 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1267 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1268 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1269 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1270
1271 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1272 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1273 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1274 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1275 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1276
1277 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1278 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1279 used to start booting.
1280
1281 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1282 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1283 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1284 multiple audio codec chips).
1285 This interacts with software
1286 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1287 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1288 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1289 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1290 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1291 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1292 audio or video codecs are used.
1293
1294 @end itemize
1295
1296 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1297 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1298 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1299 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1300 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1301 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1302 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1303 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1304 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1305 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1306
1307
1308 @node Config File Guidelines
1309 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1310
1311 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1312 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1313 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1314 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1315
1316 You should find the following directories under
1317 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1318 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1319 @itemize @bullet
1320 @item @file{interface} ...
1321 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1322 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1323 @item @file{board} ...
1324 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1325 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1326
1327 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1328 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1329 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1330 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1331 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1332 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1333 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1334 a CPU and an FPGA.
1335 @item @file{target} ...
1336 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1337 on a chip
1338 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1339 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1340 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1341 the target config file defines all of them.
1342 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1343 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1344 @end itemize
1345
1346 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1347 file may override features in any of the above files by
1348 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1349 commands specific to their situation.
1350
1351 @section Interface Config Files
1352
1353 The user config file
1354 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1355
1356 @example
1357 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1358 @end example
1359
1360 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1361 in use today with OpenOCD.
1362 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1363 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1364
1365 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1366 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1367 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1368 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1369 and need to provide a driver for it.
1370
1371 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1372 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1373 @end deffn
1374
1375 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1376 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1377 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1378 to use @command{find}, instead.
1379 @end deffn
1380
1381 @section Board Config Files
1382 @cindex config file, board
1383 @cindex board config file
1384
1385 The user config file
1386 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1387
1388 @example
1389 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1390 @end example
1391
1392 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1393 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1394 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1395
1396 @enumerate
1397 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1398 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1399 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1400 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1401 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1402 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1403 @end enumerate
1404
1405 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1406 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1407 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1408 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1409
1410 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1411 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1412 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1413 configuration works.
1414
1415 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1416
1417 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1418 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1419 convention on how to use certain variables.
1420
1421 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1422 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1423 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1424 used at will within a target configuration file.
1425
1426 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1427 for a board with three chips:
1428
1429 @example
1430 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1431 set CHIPNAME network
1432 set ENDIAN big
1433 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1434 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1435 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1436 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1437
1438 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1439 set CHIPNAME video
1440 set ENDIAN little
1441 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1442 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1443 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1444 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1445
1446 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1447 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1448 unset ENDIAN
1449 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1450 @end example
1451
1452 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1453 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1454 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1455 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1456 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1457 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1458 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1459 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1460
1461 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1462 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1463 naming collisions.
1464
1465 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1466 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1467 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1468 up other clocks and peripherals.
1469
1470 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1471 @cindex variable names
1472
1473 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1474 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1475 one such chip (as shown above).
1476 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1477 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1478 to promote consistency and
1479 so that board files can override target defaults.
1480
1481 Inputs to target config files include:
1482
1483 @itemize @bullet
1484 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1485 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1486 tap identifier dotted names.
1487 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1488 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1489 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1490 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1491 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1492 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1493 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1494 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1495 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1496 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1497 @end itemize
1498
1499 Outputs from target config files include:
1500
1501 @itemize @bullet
1502 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1503 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1504 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1505 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1506 specific to that board and that target.
1507 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1508 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1509 @end itemize
1510
1511 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1512 @cindex event, reset-init
1513 @cindex reset-init handler
1514
1515 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1516 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1517 fully set up yet.
1518 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1519 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1520 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1521 handler is one of the most important.
1522
1523 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1524 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1525 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1526 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1527 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1528
1529 @quotation Note
1530 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1531 are included here.
1532 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1533 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1534 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1535 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1536 @end quotation
1537
1538 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1539 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1540 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1541 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1542 those as parameters.
1543 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1544 and disabling the watchdog.
1545 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1546 the next developer doing such work.
1547 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1548
1549 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1550 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1551 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1552 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1553
1554 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1555
1556 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1557 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1558 a low JTAG clock rate.
1559 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1560 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1561 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1562 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1563 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1564 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1565 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1566
1567 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1568 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1569 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1570 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1571 which might be less than that.
1572
1573 @quotation Warning
1574 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1575 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1576 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1577 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1578 @end quotation
1579
1580 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1581 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1582 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1583 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1584 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1585 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1586
1587 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1588 @subsection The init_board procedure
1589 @cindex init_board procedure
1590
1591 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1592 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1593 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1594 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1595 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1596 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1597 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1598 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1599 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1600 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1601 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1602 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1603
1604 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1605 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1606
1607 @example
1608 ### board_file.cfg ###
1609
1610 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1611 source [find target/target.cfg]
1612
1613 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1614 # enables fast on-board clock source
1615 # configures the chip to use it
1616 @}
1617
1618 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1619 proc init_board @{@} @{
1620 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1621
1622 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1623 adapter speed 100
1624 @}
1625
1626 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1627 enable_fast_clock
1628 adapter speed 10000
1629 @}
1630 @}
1631 @end example
1632
1633 @section Target Config Files
1634 @cindex config file, target
1635 @cindex target config file
1636
1637 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1638 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1639 more target config files like this:
1640
1641 @example
1642 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1643 @end example
1644
1645 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1646 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1647 In summary the target files should contain
1648
1649 @enumerate
1650 @item Set defaults
1651 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1652 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1653 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1654 @item On-Chip flash
1655 @end enumerate
1656
1657 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1658 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1659 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1660
1661 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1662 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1663 can talk to the chip.
1664 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1665 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1666 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1667 and other processing engines.
1668
1669 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1670
1671 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1672 letting board config files express environment-specific
1673 differences in how things should be set up.
1674
1675 @example
1676 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1677 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1678 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1679 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1680 @} else @{
1681 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1682 @}
1683
1684 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1685 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1686 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _ENDIAN little
1689 @}
1690
1691 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1692 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1693 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1694 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1695 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1696 @} else @{
1697 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1698 @}
1699 @end example
1700 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1701
1702 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1703 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1704 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1705
1706 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1707 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1708 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1709
1710 @example
1711 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1712 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1713 @end example
1714
1715 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1716 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1717 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1718 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1719 for taps.
1720
1721 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1722 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1723 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1724 looks (in part) like this:
1725
1726 @example
1727 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1728 @end example
1729
1730 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1731 to source such a config file twice, with different
1732 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1733 it adds a different TAP each time.
1734
1735 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1736 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1737 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1738 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1739
1740 @example
1741 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1742 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1743 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1744 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1745 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1746 @end example
1747
1748 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1749 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1750
1751 @itemize
1752 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1753 plus a JRC to enable them
1754 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1755 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1756 is not currently used)
1757 @end itemize
1758
1759 @subsection Add CPU targets
1760
1761 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1762 GDB and other commands can use it.
1763 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1764 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1765 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1766 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1767
1768 @example
1769 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1770 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1771 @end example
1772
1773 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1774 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1775 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1776 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1777 a work area if you can.
1778 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1779
1780 @example
1781 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1782 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1783 @end example
1784
1785 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1786 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1787 @cindex SMP
1788 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1789
1790 @example
1791 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1792 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1793 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1794 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1795 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1796 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1797 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1798 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1799 @end example
1800 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1801 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1802 @itemize @bullet
1803 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1804 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1805 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1806 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1807 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1808 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1809 @end itemize
1810
1811 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1812 command have been implemented.
1813 @itemize @bullet
1814 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1815 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1816 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1817 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1818 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1819 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1820 following example.
1821 @end itemize
1822
1823 @example
1824 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1826 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1829 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1830 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1831 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1832 > resume
1833 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1834 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1835 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1836 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1837 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1838 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1839 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1840 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1841 @end example
1842
1843
1844 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1845
1846 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1847 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1848 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1849
1850 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1851 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1852 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1853 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1854 both signals.
1855
1856 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1857 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1858 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1859 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1860 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1861 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1862 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1863 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1864 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1865 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1866 not available.)
1867
1868 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1869 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1870 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1871 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1872 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1873 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1874 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1875 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1876
1877 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1878 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1879 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1880 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1881 slower clock than they will use later.
1882 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1883 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1884 than they will use later.
1885 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1886
1887 @quotation Important
1888 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1889 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1890 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1891 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1892 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1893 @end quotation
1894
1895 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1896 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1897 @cindex init_targets procedure
1898
1899 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1900 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1901 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1902 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1903 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1904 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1905 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1906 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1907 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1908
1909 @example
1910 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1911
1912 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1913 # basic initialization procedure ...
1914 @}
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1919 @}
1920
1921 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1922
1923 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1924
1925 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1926 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1927 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1928 @}
1929 @end example
1930
1931 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1932 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1933
1934 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1935
1936 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1938
1939 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1940 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1941 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1942
1943 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1944 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1945 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1946 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1947 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1948 events already assigned.
1949
1950 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1951
1952 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1953 special high speed download features - enable it.
1954
1955 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1956
1957 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1958 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1959 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1960 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1961 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1962 If you are using an external trace port,
1963 configure it in your board config file.
1964 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1965 configure it in your target config file.
1966
1967 @example
1968 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1969 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1970 @end example
1971
1972 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1973
1974 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1975
1976 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1977 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1978 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1979 the TARGET (chip) file.
1980
1981 Examples:
1982 @itemize @bullet
1983 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1984 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1985 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1986 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1987 @end itemize
1988
1989 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1990 @section Translating Configuration Files
1991 @cindex translation
1992 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1993 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1994 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1995 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1996 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1997 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1998
1999 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2000 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2001 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2002 convert other scripts later on.
2003
2004 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2005 replace job:
2006
2007 @example
2008 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2009 #
2010 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2011 #
2012 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2013 #
2014 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2015
2016 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2017 global TARGETNAME
2018
2019 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2020
2021 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2022 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2023 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2024 @}
2025 @end example
2026
2027
2028
2029 @node Server Configuration
2030 @chapter Server Configuration
2031 @cindex initialization
2032 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2033 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2034 supported.
2035
2036 @anchor{configurationstage}
2037 @section Configuration Stage
2038 @cindex configuration stage
2039 @cindex config command
2040
2041 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2042 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2043 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2044 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2045 inside startup scripts.
2046
2047 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2048 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2049 which may be issued interactively.
2050 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2051 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2052
2053 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2054 flash banks,
2055 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2056 and other basic setup.
2057 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2058 may access or activate TAPs.
2059 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2060 longer be issued.
2061
2062 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2063 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2064 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2065 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2066 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2067
2068 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2069 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2070 the command can be executed in either
2071 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2072 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2073 @end deffn
2074
2075 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2076 @section Entering the Run Stage
2077
2078 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2079 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2080 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2081 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2082 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2083 You should see no errors at this point.
2084 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2085 commands you used to configure the server.
2086 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2087 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2088 on the scan chain.
2089
2090 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2091 become available.
2092 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2093 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2094 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2095 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2096 entry to the run stage.
2097
2098 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2099 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2100 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2101 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2102 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2103 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2104 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2105
2106 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2107 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2108 configuration files and/or command line options.
2109
2110 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2111 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2112 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2113 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2114 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2115
2116 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2117 corresponding subsystems:
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2119 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2120 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2121 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2122 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2123 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2124 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2125 @end deffn
2126
2127 At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
2128 the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
2129 same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
2130 the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
2131 @example
2132 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
2133 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
2134 @end example
2135 @end deffn
2136
2137 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2138 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2139 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2140 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2141 the run stage.
2142 @end deffn
2143
2144 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2145 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2146 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2147
2148 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2149 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2150 scan chain.
2151 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2152 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2153
2154 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2155 they return.
2156 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2157 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2158 @end deffn
2159
2160 @anchor{tcpipports}
2161 @section TCP/IP Ports
2162 @cindex TCP port
2163 @cindex server
2164 @cindex port
2165 @cindex security
2166 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2167 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2168 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2169
2170 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2171 access using one or more of these ports.
2172 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2173 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2174 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2175
2176 @anchor{gdb_port}
2177 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2178 @cindex GDB server
2179 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2180 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2181 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2182 the normal use cases.
2183
2184 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2185 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2186 disables the gdb server.
2187
2188 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2189 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2190
2191 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2192 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2193 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2194
2195 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2196 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2197 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2198 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2199 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2200 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2201 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2202 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2203 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2204
2205 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2206 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2207 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2208 @end deffn
2209
2210 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2211 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2212 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2213 output from the Tcl engine.
2214 Intended as a machine interface.
2215 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2216 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2217 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2218 @end deffn
2219
2220 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2221 Specify or query the
2222 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2223 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2224 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2225 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2226 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2230 @section GDB Configuration
2231 @cindex GDB
2232 @cindex GDB configuration
2233 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2234 The ones listed here are static and global.
2235 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2236 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2237
2238 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2239 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2240 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2241 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2242 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2243 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2244 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2245 @end deffn
2246
2247 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2248 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2249 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2250 vFlash packet is received.
2251 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2252 @end deffn
2253
2254 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2255 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2256 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2257 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2258 for flash programming to work.
2259 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2260 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2261 @end deffn
2262
2263 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2264 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2265 by GDB memory read packets.
2266 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2267 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2268 @end deffn
2269
2270 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2271 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2272 packets report errors or not.
2273 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2274 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2275 @end deffn
2276
2277 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2278 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2279 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2280 @end deffn
2281
2282 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2283 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2284
2285 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2286 @end deffn
2287
2288 @anchor{eventpolling}
2289 @section Event Polling
2290
2291 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2292 where significant events can happen at any time.
2293 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2294 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2295 or to GDB.
2296
2297 Examples of such events include:
2298
2299 @itemize
2300 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2301 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2302 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2303 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2304 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2305 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2306 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2307 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2308 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2309 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2310 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2311 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2312 @end itemize
2313
2314 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2315 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2316 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2317 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2318 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2319
2320 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2321 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2322 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2323 to the various active targets.
2324 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2325 which is normally done in the background.
2326
2327 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2328 Poll the current target for its current state.
2329 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2330 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2331 specific information about the current state is printed.
2332 An optional parameter
2333 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2334
2335 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2336 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2337 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2338 @example
2339 > poll
2340 background polling: on
2341 target state: halted
2342 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2343 current mode: Supervisor
2344 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2345 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2346 >
2347 @end example
2348 @end deffn
2349
2350 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2351 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2352 @cindex config file, interface
2353 @cindex interface config file
2354
2355 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2356 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2357 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2358
2359 @quotation Note
2360 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2361 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2362 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2363 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2364 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2365 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2366 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2367 @end quotation
2368
2369 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2370 through commands in an interface configuration
2371 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2372 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2373
2374 @example
2375 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2376 @end example
2377
2378 These commands tell
2379 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2380 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2381
2382 @example
2383 # jlink interface
2384 adapter driver jlink
2385 @end example
2386
2387 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2388
2389
2390 @section Adapter Configuration
2391
2392 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2393 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2394 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2395
2396 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2397 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2398 target.
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2402 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2403 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2404 @end deffn
2405 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2406 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2407 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2408 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2409 the hardware can support.
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412
2413
2414 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2415 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2419 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2420 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2421 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2422 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2423 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2424 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2425
2426 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2427 @end deffn
2428
2429 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2430 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2431 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2432 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2433 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2434 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2435 @end deffn
2436
2437 @section Interface Drivers
2438
2439 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2440 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2441 available at run time.
2442
2443 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2444 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2445 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2446 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2447
2448 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2449 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2450 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2454 Displays status of RTCK option.
2455 Optionally sets that option first.
2456 @end deffn
2457 @end deffn
2458
2459 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2460 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2461 This has one driver-specific command:
2462
2463 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2464 Logs some status
2465 @end deffn
2466 @end deffn
2467
2468 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2469 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2470 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2471 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2472 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2473 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2474 @end deffn
2475
2476 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2477 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2478 or v2 (USB bulk).
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2481 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2482 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2483 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2484 @example
2485 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2486 @end example
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2490 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2491
2492 @itemize @minus
2493 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2494 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2495 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2496 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2497 @end itemize
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2501 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2502 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2503 interface string or for user class interface.
2504 @end deffn
2505
2506 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2507 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2508 @end deffn
2509
2510 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2511 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2512 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2513
2514 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2515 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2516 are logged.
2517 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2518 @end deffn
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2522 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2526 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2530 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2531 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2532
2533 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2534 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2535
2536 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2537 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2538
2539 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2540 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2541 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2542 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2543 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2544 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2545
2546 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2547 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2548 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2549 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2550 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2551
2552 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2553 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2554 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2555 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2556
2557 @itemize @minus
2558 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2559 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2560 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2561 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2562 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2563 switching data and direction as necessary
2564 @end itemize
2565
2566 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2567 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2568
2569 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2570 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2571 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2572 @example
2573 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2574 @end example
2575 @end deffn
2576
2577 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2578 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2579 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2580 during device selection.
2581 @end deffn
2582
2583 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2584 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2585 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2586 @end deffn
2587
2588 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2589 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2590 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2591 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2592 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2593 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2594 and initially asserted reset signals.
2595 @end deffn
2596
2597 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2598 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2599 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2600 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2601 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2602 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2603 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2604 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2605 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2606 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2607 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2608
2609 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2610 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2611 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2612 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2613 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2614 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2615
2616 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2617 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2618 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2619 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2620 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2621 are always driven by the FTDI.
2622
2623 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2624 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2625 @var{name}.
2626 @end deffn
2627
2628 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2629 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2630 @itemize @minus
2631 @item @option{0}, drive low
2632 @item @option{1}, drive high
2633 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2634 @end itemize
2635 @end deffn
2636
2637 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2638 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2642 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2643
2644 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2645 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2646 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2647 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2648 @itemize @minus
2649 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2650 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2651 @end itemize
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2655 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2656
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2660 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2661 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2662 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2663
2664 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2665 @itemize @minus
2666 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2667 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2668 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2669 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2670 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2671 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2672 @end itemize
2673
2674 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2675 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2676 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2677 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2678 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2679 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2680 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2681 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2682
2683 FT232R
2684 @itemize @minus
2685 @item bit 7 - RI
2686 @item bit 6 - DCD
2687 @item bit 5 - DSR
2688 @item bit 4 - DTR
2689 @item bit 3 - CTS
2690 @item bit 2 - RTS
2691 @item bit 1 - RXD
2692 @item bit 0 - TXD
2693 @end itemize
2694
2695 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2696 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2697
2698 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2699 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2700 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2701 @end deffn
2702
2703 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2704 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2705 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2706 @end deffn
2707
2708 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2709 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2710 @end deffn
2711
2712 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2713 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2714 @end deffn
2715
2716 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2717 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2721 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2722 @end deffn
2723
2724 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2725 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2729 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2730 @end deffn
2731
2732 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2733 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2734 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2735 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2736 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2737 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2738 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2739 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2740 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2741 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2742 @end deffn
2743
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2747 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2748 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2749 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2750
2751 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2752 processors which are being simulated.
2753
2754 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2755 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2756 sockets instead of TCP.
2757 @end deffn
2758
2759 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2760 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2761 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2762 @end deffn
2763
2764 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2765 something like:
2766
2767 @example
2768 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2769 remote_bitbang port 3335
2770 remote_bitbang host foobar
2771 @end example
2772
2773 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2774 named mysocket:
2775
2776 @example
2777 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2778 remote_bitbang port 0
2779 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2780 @end example
2781 @end deffn
2782
2783 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2784 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2785 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2786 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2787
2788 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2789 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2790 default values are used.
2791 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2792 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2793 @example
2794 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2795 @end example
2796 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2797 @example
2798 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2799 @end example
2800 @end deffn
2801
2802 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2803 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2804 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2805 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2806 target board.
2807
2808 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2809 @example
2810 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2811 reset_config srst_only
2812 @end example
2813 @end deffn
2814
2815 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2816 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2817 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2818 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2819 @end deffn
2820
2821 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2822 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2823 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2824 @end deffn
2825
2826 @end deffn
2827
2828 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2829 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2830 This has one driver-specific command:
2831
2832 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2833 Display either the address of the I/O port
2834 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2835 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2836 This is a write-once setting.
2837 @end deffn
2838 @end deffn
2839
2840 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2841 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2842 transports.
2843
2844 @quotation Compatibility Note
2845 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2846 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2847 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2848 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2849 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2850 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2851 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2852 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2853 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2854 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2855 @end quotation
2856
2857 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2858 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2859 states.
2860 @end deffn
2861 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2862 Display free device internal memory.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2865 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2866 command version.
2867 @end deffn
2868 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2869 Display the device configuration.
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2872 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2873 power state.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2876 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2877 @end deffn
2878 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2879 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2880 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2881 IP configuration.
2882 @end deffn
2883 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2884 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2885 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2886 @end deffn
2887 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2888 Reset the current configuration.
2889 @end deffn
2890 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2891 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2892 @end deffn
2893 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2894 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2895 pairs.
2896
2897 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2898 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2899 @example
2900 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2901 @end example
2902 @end deffn
2903 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2904 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2905 pairs.
2906
2907 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2908 @example
2909 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2910 77a90000
2911 @end example
2912 @end deffn
2913 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2914 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2915 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2916 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2917 the serial number instead, if possible.
2918
2919 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2920 @end deffn
2921 @end deffn
2922
2923 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2924 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2925 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2926 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2927 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2928 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2929 configuration script.
2930
2931 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2932 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2933 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2934 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2935 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2936
2937 Known limitations:
2938 @itemize @bullet
2939 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2940 and 2.7 MHz.
2941 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2942 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2943 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2944 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2945 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2946 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2947 communications with the target.
2948 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2949 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2950 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2951 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2952 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2953 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2954 @end itemize
2955
2956 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2957 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2958 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2959 @end deffn
2960
2961 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2962 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2963 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2964 target as a side-effect.
2965 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2966 @end deffn
2967
2968 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2969 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2970 version, and target voltage.
2971 @end deffn
2972 @end deffn
2973
2974 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2975 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2976 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2977 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2978 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2979
2980 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2981 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2982 This is a write-once setting.
2983 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2984
2985 @itemize @minus
2986 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2987 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2988 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2989 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2990 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2991 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2992 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2993 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2994 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2995 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2996 some versions of
2997 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2998 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2999 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3000 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3001 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3002 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3003 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3004 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3005 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3006 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3007 @end itemize
3008 @end deffn
3009
3010 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
3011 Display either the address of the I/O port
3012 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3013 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3014 This is a write-once setting.
3015
3016 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3017 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3018 you may encounter a problem.
3019 @end deffn
3020
3021 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3022 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3023 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3024 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3025 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3026 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3027
3028 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3029 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3030 @quotation Tip
3031 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3032 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3033 @example
3034 > parport toggling_time 1000
3035 > adapter speed 500
3036 @end example
3037 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3038 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3039 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3040 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3041 large set of samples.
3042 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3043 @example
3044 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3045 @end example
3046 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3047 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3048
3049 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3050 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3051 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3052 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3053 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3054 be conservative.
3055 @end quotation
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3059 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3060 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3061 @end deffn
3062
3063 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3064 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3065
3066 @example
3067 adapter driver parport
3068 parport port 0x278
3069 parport cable wiggler
3070 @end example
3071 @end deffn
3072
3073 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3074 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3075 @end deffn
3076
3077 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3078 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3082 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3083 @end deffn
3084
3085 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3086 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3087
3088 @quotation Note
3089 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3090 which are not currently documented here.
3091 @end quotation
3092 @end deffn
3093
3094 @anchor{hla_interface}
3095 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3096 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3097 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3098 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3099
3100 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3101 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3102 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3103 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3104 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3105 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3106
3107 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3108 Currently Not Supported.
3109 @end deffn
3110
3111 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3112 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3113 @end deffn
3114
3115 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3116 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3117 @end deffn
3118
3119 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3120 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3121 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3122
3123 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3124 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3125 ST-LINK server software module}.
3126 @end deffn
3127
3128 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3129 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3130 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3131 @end deffn
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3135 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3136 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3137 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3138 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3139
3140 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3141 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3142 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3143 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3144
3145 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3146 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3147
3148 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3149 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3150 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3151
3152 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3153 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3154 ST-LINK server software module}.
3155
3156 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3157 @end deffn
3158
3159 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3160 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3161 @end deffn
3162
3163 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3164 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3165 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3166
3167 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3168 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3169 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3170 the target's supply voltage.
3171 @example
3172 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3173 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3174 @end example
3175 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3176 @example
3177 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3178 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3179 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3180 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3181 3.24891518738
3182 @end example
3183 @end deffn
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3187 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3188 @end deffn
3189
3190 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3191 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3192 @end deffn
3193
3194 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3195 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3196 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3197 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3198 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3199
3200 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3201 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3202 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3203 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3204 @end deffn
3205
3206 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3207 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3208 version).
3209 @end deffn
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3213 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3214 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3215 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3216 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3217
3218 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3219
3220 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3221 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3222
3223 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3224 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3225
3226 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3227
3228 @end deffn
3229 @end deffn
3230
3231 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3232 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3233 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3234
3235 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3236 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3237 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3238 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3239 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3240 configuration on exit.
3241
3242 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3243
3244 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3245 pinout.
3246
3247 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3248 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3249 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3250 individually.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3254 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3255 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3259 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3260 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3261 @end deffn
3262
3263 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3264 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3265 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3266 @end deffn
3267
3268 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3269 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3270 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3271 @end deffn
3272
3273 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3274 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3275 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3276 @end deffn
3277
3278 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3279 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3280 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3281 @end deffn
3282
3283 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3284 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3285 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3286 @end deffn
3287
3288 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3289 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3290 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3291 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3292 @end deffn
3293
3294 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3295 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3296 @end deffn
3297
3298 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3299 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3300 @end deffn
3301
3302 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3303 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3304 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3308 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3309 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3310 list can be found in the
3311 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3312 @end deffn
3313
3314 @end deffn
3315
3316 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3317 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3318 of the one which is most popular.
3319
3320 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3321
3322 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3323 pinout.
3324
3325 @end deffn
3326
3327
3328 @deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
3329 Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
3330 on the two expansion headers.
3331
3332 For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
3333 registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
3334 kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
3335 be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
3336
3337 All four GPIO ports are available. GPIOs numbered 0 to 31 are mapped to GPIO port
3338 0, GPIO numbers 32 to 63 are mapped to GPIO port 1 and so on.
3339
3340 See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3341
3342 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3343 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3344 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3345 individually.
3346 @end deffn
3347
3348 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3349 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3350 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3351 @end deffn
3352
3353 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3354 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3355 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3356 @end deffn
3357
3358 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3359 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3360 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3361 @end deffn
3362
3363 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3364 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3365 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio jtag_nums}.
3366 @end deffn
3367
3368 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3369 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3370 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3371 @end deffn
3372
3373 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3374 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3375 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio swd_nums}.
3376 @end deffn
3377
3378 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3379 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3380 specified using the configuration command @command{am335xgpio swd_nums}.
3381 @end deffn
3382
3383 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio_dir}
3384 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3385 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin. The direction
3386 control state can be set with the command @command{am335xgpio
3387 swdio_dir_output_state}. If not specified this feature is disabled.
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio swdio_dir_output_state} @var{output_state}
3391 Set the state required for an external SWDIO buffer to be an output. Valid
3392 values are @option{on} (default) and @option{off}.
3393 @end deffn
3394
3395 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3396 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3397 @end deffn
3398
3399 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3400 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3401 @end deffn
3402
3403 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio led_num} @var{led}
3404 Set activity LED GPIO number. If not specified an activity LED is not enabled.
3405 @end deffn
3406
3407 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio led_on_state} @var{on_state}
3408 Set required logic level for the LED to be on. Valid values are @option{on}
3409 (default) and @option{off}.
3410 @end deffn
3411
3412 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3413 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
3414 speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
3415 @end deffn
3416
3417 @end deffn
3418
3419
3420 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3421 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3422 The driver emulates either JTAG or SWD transport through bitbanging.
3423
3424 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3425
3426 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod gpiochip} @var{chip}
3427 Set the GPIO chip number for all GPIOs used by linuxgpiod. If GPIOs use
3428 different GPIO chips then the individual GPIO configuration commands (i.e., not
3429 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums} or @command{linuxgpiod swd_nums}) can be used to
3430 set chip numbers independently for each GPIO.
3431 @end deffn
3432
3433 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3434 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order). Must
3435 be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3436 individually.
3437 @end deffn
3438
3439 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod tck_num} [@var{chip}] @var{tck}
3440 Set TCK GPIO number, and optionally TCK chip number. Must be specified to enable
3441 JTAG transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3442 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums}.
3443 @end deffn
3444
3445 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod tms_num} [@var{chip}] @var{tms}
3446 Set TMS GPIO number, and optionally TMS chip number. Must be specified to enable
3447 JTAG transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3448 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums}.
3449 @end deffn
3450
3451 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod tdo_num} [@var{chip}] @var{tdo}
3452 Set TDO GPIO number, and optionally TDO chip number. Must be specified to enable
3453 JTAG transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3454 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums}.
3455 @end deffn
3456
3457 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod tdi_num} [@var{chip}] @var{tdi}
3458 Set TDI GPIO number, and optionally TDI chip number. Must be specified to enable
3459 JTAG transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3460 @command{linuxgpiod jtag_nums}.
3461 @end deffn
3462
3463 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod trst_num} [@var{chip}] @var{trst}
3464 Set TRST GPIO number, and optionally TRST chip number. Must be specified to
3465 enable TRST.
3466 @end deffn
3467
3468 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3469 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3470 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified
3471 individually.
3472 @end deffn
3473
3474 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod swclk_num} [@var{chip}] @var{swclk}
3475 Set SWCLK GPIO number, and optionally SWCLK chip number. Must be specified to
3476 enable SWD transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3477 @command{linuxgpiod swd_nums}.
3478 @end deffn
3479
3480 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod swdio_num} [@var{chip}] @var{swdio}
3481 Set SWDIO GPIO number, and optionally SWDIO chip number. Must be specified to
3482 enable SWD transport. Can also be specified using the configuration command
3483 @command{linuxgpiod swd_nums}.
3484 @end deffn
3485
3486 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod swdio_dir_num} [@var{chip}] @var{swdio_dir}
3487 Set SWDIO direction control GPIO number, and optionally SWDIO direction control
3488 chip number. If specified, this GPIO can be used to control the direction of an
3489 external buffer connected to the SWDIO GPIO (set=output mode, clear=input mode).
3490 @end deffn
3491
3492 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod srst_num} [@var{chip}] @var{srst}
3493 Set SRST GPIO number, and optionally SRST chip number. Must be specified to
3494 enable SRST.
3495 @end deffn
3496
3497 @deffn {Config Command} {linuxgpiod led_num} [@var{chip}] @var{led}
3498 Set activity LED GPIO number, and optionally activity LED chip number. If not
3499 specified an activity LED is not enabled.
3500 @end deffn
3501
3502 @end deffn
3503
3504
3505 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3506 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3507 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3508
3509 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3510 @end deffn
3511
3512
3513 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3514 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3515 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3516
3517 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3518 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3519 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3520
3521 @itemize @minus
3522 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3523 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3524 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3525 @end itemize
3526 @end deffn
3527
3528 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3529 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3530 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3531 @end deffn
3532 @end deffn
3533
3534
3535 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
3536 Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
3537
3538 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
3539 Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
3540 @end deffn
3541
3542 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
3543 Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
3544 0 for no batching
3545 1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
3546 2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
3547 @end deffn
3548
3549 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
3550 Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
3551 debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
3552 around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
3553 timeout value.
3554 @end deffn
3555
3556 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
3557 Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
3558 The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
3559 The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
3560 @end deffn
3561
3562 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
3563 Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
3564 Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
3565 The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
3566 Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
3567 @end deffn
3568 @end deffn
3569
3570 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3571 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3572 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3573 DPI server interface.
3574
3575 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3576 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3577 @end deffn
3578
3579 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3580 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3581 @end deffn
3582 @end deffn
3583
3584
3585 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3586
3587 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3588 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3589
3590 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3591 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3592
3593 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3594 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3595 @example
3596 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3597 @end example
3598 @end deffn
3599
3600 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3601 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3602 @example
3603 buspirate speed normal
3604 @end example
3605 @end deffn
3606
3607 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3608 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3609 @itemize @minus
3610 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3611 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3612 @end itemize
3613 For example:
3614 @example
3615 buspirate mode normal
3616 @end example
3617 @end deffn
3618
3619 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3620 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3621 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3622 For example:
3623 @example
3624 buspirate pullup 0
3625 @end example
3626 @end deffn
3627
3628 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3629 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3630 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3631 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3632 @example
3633 buspirate vreg 0
3634 @end example
3635 @end deffn
3636
3637 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3638 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3639 @end deffn
3640 @example
3641 buspirate led 1
3642 @end example
3643
3644 @end deffn
3645
3646
3647 @section Transport Configuration
3648 @cindex Transport
3649 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3650 and the debug adapter you are using,
3651 several transports may be available to
3652 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3653 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3654 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3655 version of OpenOCD.
3656 @end deffn
3657
3658 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3659 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3660
3661 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3662 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3663 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3664 adapter's driver).
3665
3666 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3667 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3668 supported by the debug adapter.
3669
3670 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3671 transport, if any.
3672 @end deffn
3673
3674 @subsection JTAG Transport
3675 @cindex JTAG
3676 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3677 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3678 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3679 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3680 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3681 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3682
3683 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3684 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3685 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3686 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3687 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3688
3689 @subsection SWD Transport
3690 @cindex SWD
3691 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3692 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3693 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3694 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3695 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3696 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3697 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3698
3699 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3700 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3701 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3702 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3703 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3704
3705 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3706 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3707 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3708 expected to change.
3709 @end deffn
3710
3711 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3712 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3713 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3714 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3715 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3716 DAPs are created.
3717
3718 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3719 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3720 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3721
3722 @subsection SPI Transport
3723 @cindex SPI
3724 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3725 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3726 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3727 solution for flash programming.
3728
3729 @anchor{swimtransport}
3730 @subsection SWIM Transport
3731 @cindex SWIM
3732 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3733 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3734 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3735 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3736
3737 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3738
3739 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3740
3741 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3742 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3743 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3744 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3745 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3746
3747 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3748 @section JTAG Speed
3749 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3750 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3751 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3752 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3753 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3754 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3755 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3756 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3757 power management software that may be active.
3758
3759 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3760 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3761 target event handler.
3762 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3763 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3764 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3765 sets up those clocks).
3766 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3767 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3768 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3769 in the target config file.
3770 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3771 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3772 config file instead.
3773 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3774 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3775 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3776
3777 @example
3778 jtag_rclk 3000
3779 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3780 @end example
3781
3782 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3783 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3784 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3785 may not be the fastest solution.
3786
3787 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3788 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3789 which support adaptive clocking.
3790
3791 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3792 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3793 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3794 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3795 than the speed specified.
3796
3797 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3798 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3799 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3800 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3801
3802 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3803 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3804 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3805 JTAG clocking after setup.
3806 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3807 If the interface device can not
3808 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3809 @end deffn
3810
3811 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3812 @cindex adaptive clocking
3813 @cindex RTCK
3814 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3815 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3816 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3817 @example
3818 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3819 jtag_rclk 3000
3820 @end example
3821 @end defun
3822
3823 @node Reset Configuration
3824 @chapter Reset Configuration
3825 @cindex Reset Configuration
3826
3827 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3828 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3829 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3830 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3831 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3832 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3833 Please see the various board files for examples.
3834
3835 @quotation Note
3836 To maintainers and integrators:
3837 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3838 Normally the board configuration file
3839 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3840 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3841
3842 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3843 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3844 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3845 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3846 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3847 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3848 @end quotation
3849
3850 @section Types of Reset
3851
3852 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3853 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3854 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3855
3856 @itemize @bullet
3857 @item
3858 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3859 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3860 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3861 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3862 @item
3863 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3864 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3865 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3866 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3867 @item
3868 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3869 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3870 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3871 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3872 @item
3873 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3874 several other types of reset.
3875 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3876 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3877 There may be individual module resets.
3878 @end itemize
3879
3880 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3881 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3882 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3883 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3884 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3885 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3886 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3887 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3888 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3889
3890 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3891 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3892
3893 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3894 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3895 common issues are:
3896
3897 @itemize @bullet
3898
3899 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3900 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3901 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3902 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3903 when either of those signals is not connected.
3904 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3905 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3906 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3907 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3908
3909 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3910 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3911 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3912 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3913
3914 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3915 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3916 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3917 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3918 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3919 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3920 hardware debouncing.
3921 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3922 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3923
3924 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3925 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3926 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3927 to use push/pull output drivers.
3928 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3929 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3930 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3931 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3932
3933 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3934 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3935 issues (not limited to errata).
3936 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3937 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3938 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3939 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3940 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3941 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3942 @end itemize
3943
3944 There can also be other issues.
3945 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3946 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3947 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3948 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3949 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3950 Agreement (NDA).
3951
3952 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3953 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3954 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3955
3956 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3957 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3958
3959 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3960
3961 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3962 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3963 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3964 allowing it to be deasserted.
3965 @end deffn
3966
3967 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3968 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3969 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3970 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3971 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3972 @end deffn
3973
3974 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3975 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3976 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3977 allowing it to be deasserted.
3978 @end deffn
3979
3980 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3981 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3982 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3983 @end deffn
3984
3985 @anchor{reset_config}
3986 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3987 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3988 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3989 configuration scripts.
3990
3991 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3992 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3993 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3994 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3995 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3996 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3997 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3998 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3999
4000 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
4001 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
4002 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
4003 -- may be specified at a time.
4004 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
4005 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
4006 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
4007 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
4008 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
4009
4010 @itemize
4011 @item
4012 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
4013 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
4014 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
4015 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
4016 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
4017
4018 @quotation Tip
4019 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
4020 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
4021 @end quotation
4022
4023 @item
4024 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
4025 signal implementations.
4026 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
4027 indicating everything behaves normally.
4028 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
4029 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
4030 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
4031 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
4032 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
4033 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
4034 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
4035
4036 @item
4037 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4038 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
4039 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
4040 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
4041 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
4042 while SRST is asserted.
4043 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
4044 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
4045
4046 @item
4047 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
4048 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
4049 is required to use this option.
4050 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
4051 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
4052 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
4053 be asserted before any target connection.
4054 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
4055 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
4056 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
4057 @end itemize
4058
4059 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
4060 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
4061 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
4062 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
4063 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
4064
4065 @itemize
4066 @item
4067 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
4068 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
4069 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
4070 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
4071
4072 @item
4073 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
4074 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
4075 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
4076 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
4077 power-up and pressing a reset button.
4078 @end itemize
4079 @end deffn
4080
4081 @section Custom Reset Handling
4082 @cindex events
4083
4084 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
4085 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
4086 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
4087 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
4088 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
4089 at particular points in the reset sequence.
4090
4091 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
4092 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
4093 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
4094 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
4095 want to reset everything at once.
4096
4097 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
4098 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
4099 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
4100 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
4101 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
4102 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
4103 needs special attention.
4104
4105 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
4106 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
4107 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
4108 to find a sequence of operations that works.
4109 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
4110 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
4111 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
4112 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
4113 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
4114
4115 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
4116 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
4117 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
4118 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
4119 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
4120
4121 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
4122 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
4123 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
4124 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
4125 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
4126 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
4127 low level reset command (@option{halt},
4128 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
4129 or potentially some other value.
4130
4131 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
4132 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
4133 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
4134 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
4135 (or their associated targets)
4136 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
4137
4138 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
4139 they return.
4140 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
4141 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
4142 @end deffn
4143
4144 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
4145 This validates the scan chain using just the four
4146 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
4147 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
4148 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
4149 matches the TAPs it can observe.
4150 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
4151 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
4152 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
4153 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
4154 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
4155 @end deffn
4156
4157 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
4158 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
4159 everything on the JTAG scan chain
4160 (and anything else connected to SRST).
4161 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
4162 @end deffn
4163
4164
4165 @node TAP Declaration
4166 @chapter TAP Declaration
4167 @cindex TAP declaration
4168 @cindex TAP configuration
4169
4170 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
4171 TAPs serve many roles, including:
4172
4173 @itemize @bullet
4174 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
4175 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
4176 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
4177 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
4178 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
4179 start running that code.
4180 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
4181 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
4182 and missing connections.
4183 @end itemize
4184
4185 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
4186 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
4187 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
4188 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
4189 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
4190
4191 @section Scan Chains
4192 @cindex scan chain
4193
4194 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
4195 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
4196 They also need to be added to
4197 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
4198 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
4199 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
4200 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
4201 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
4202 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
4203 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
4204 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
4205
4206 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
4207 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
4208 command, presented in the next chapter.
4209 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
4210 debugging targets.)
4211 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
4212
4213 @verbatim
4214 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
4215 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
4216 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
4217 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
4218 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
4219 @end verbatim
4220
4221 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4222 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4223 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4224 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4225 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4226 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4227 until they are told to do so.
4228
4229 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4230 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4231 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4232 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4233
4234 @example
4235 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4236 @end example
4237
4238 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4239 by a given chip.
4240 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4241 and so forth.
4242 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4243 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4244 both inside a single chip and between them.
4245 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4246
4247 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4248 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4249 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4250 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4251 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4252 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4253 includes commands something like this:
4254
4255 @example
4256 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4257 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4258 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4259 @end example
4260
4261 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4262 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4263 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4264
4265 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4266 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4267 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4268 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4269 @example
4270 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4271 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4272 @}
4273 @end example
4274 @end deffn
4275
4276 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4277 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4278 and their status.
4279 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4280 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4281 but systems with a JTAG router can
4282 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4283 @end deffn
4284
4285 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4286 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4287
4288 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4289 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4290
4291 @section TAP Names
4292 @cindex dotted name
4293
4294 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4295 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4296 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4297 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4298 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4299 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4300 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4301 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4302
4303 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4304 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4305 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4306
4307 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4308
4309 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4310 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4311 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4312
4313 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4314 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4315 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4316 overridable.
4317
4318 @cindex TAP naming convention
4319 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4320 and should follow this convention:
4321
4322 @itemize @bullet
4323 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4324 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4325 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4326 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4327 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4328 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4329 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4330 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4331 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4332 with a single TAP;
4333 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4334 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4335 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4336 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4337 @end itemize
4338
4339 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4340
4341 @itemize @bullet
4342 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4343 @*The length in bits of the
4344 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4345 @end itemize
4346
4347 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4348
4349 @itemize @bullet
4350 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4351 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4352 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4353 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4354 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4355 (the TAP is linked in).
4356 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4357 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4358 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4359 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4360 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4361 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4362 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4363 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4364 values that were found but not included in the list.
4365
4366 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4367 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4368 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4369 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4370 hardware to find these values.
4371 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4372 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4373 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4374 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4375 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4376 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4377 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4378 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4379 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4380 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4381 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4382 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4383 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4384 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4385 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4386 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4387 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4388 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4389 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4390 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4391 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4392 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4393 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4394 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4395 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4396 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4397 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4398 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4399 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4400 @end itemize
4401 @end deffn
4402
4403 @section Other TAP commands
4404
4405 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4406 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4407 @end deffn
4408
4409 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4410 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4411 At this writing this TAP attribute
4412 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4413 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4414 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4415 See the next section for information about the available events.
4416
4417 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4418 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4419 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4420 @end deffn
4421
4422 @section TAP Events
4423 @cindex events
4424 @cindex TAP events
4425
4426 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4427 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4428 The other applies to debugger targets,
4429 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4430
4431 The TAP events currently defined are:
4432
4433 @itemize @bullet
4434 @item @b{post-reset}
4435 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4436 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4437 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4438 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4439 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4440
4441 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4442 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4443 of any particular target.
4444 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4445 @item @b{setup}
4446 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4447 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4448 @item @b{tap-disable}
4449 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4450 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4451 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4452 @item @b{tap-enable}
4453 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4454 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4455 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4456 @end itemize
4457
4458 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4459 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4460 contents to be accurate), you might:
4461
4462 @example
4463 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4464 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4465 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4466 @}
4467 @end example
4468
4469
4470 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4471 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4472 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4473 @cindex jrc
4474
4475 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4476 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4477 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4478 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4479 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4480
4481 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4482 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4483 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4484 be visible.
4485 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4486 ignores, such as:
4487
4488 @itemize
4489 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4490 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4491 TAPs receive new instructions.
4492 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4493 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4494 @end itemize
4495
4496 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4497 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4498 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4499 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4500
4501 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4502 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4503
4504 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4505 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4506 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4507 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4508 should define TAP event handlers using
4509 code that looks something like this:
4510
4511 @example
4512 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4513 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4514 @}
4515 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4516 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4517 @}
4518 @end example
4519
4520 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4521
4522 @example
4523 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4524 @end example
4525
4526 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4527 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4528 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4529 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4530
4531 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4532 If necessary, disables the tap
4533 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4534 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4535 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4536 and "0" if it is disabled.
4537 @end deffn
4538
4539 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4540 If necessary, enables the tap
4541 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4542 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4543 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4544 and "0" if it is disabled.
4545 @end deffn
4546
4547 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4548 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4549 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4550 and "0" if it is disabled.
4551
4552 @quotation Note
4553 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4554 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4555 @end quotation
4556 @end deffn
4557
4558 @anchor{autoprobing}
4559 @section Autoprobing
4560 @cindex autoprobe
4561 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4562
4563 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4564 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4565 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4566 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4567
4568 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4569 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4570 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4571 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4572 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4573 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4574 right when they come out of reset).
4575
4576 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4577
4578 @example
4579 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4580 reset_config trst_and_srst
4581 jtag_rclk 8
4582 @end example
4583
4584 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4585 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4586
4587 @enumerate
4588 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4589 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4590 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4591 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4592 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4593 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4594 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4595 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4596 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4597 that is discovered.
4598 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4599 register, it will report it.
4600 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4601 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4602 @end enumerate
4603
4604 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4605 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4606 that's a bit more complex:
4607
4608 @example
4609 clock speed 8 kHz
4610 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4611 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4612 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4613 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4614 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4615 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4616 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4617 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4618 @end example
4619
4620 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4621 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4622 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4623 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4624 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4625 and so forth.
4626
4627 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4628 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4629 @cindex DAP declaration
4630
4631 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4632 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4633 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4634 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4635 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4636
4637 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4638
4639 @anchor{dap_create}
4640 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4641 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4642 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4643 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4644 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4645
4646 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4647
4648 @itemize @bullet
4649 @item @code{-adiv5}
4650 Specify that it's an ADIv5 DAP. This is the default if not specified.
4651 @item @code{-adiv6}
4652 Specify that it's an ADIv6 DAP.
4653 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4654 Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4655 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4656 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4657 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4658
4659 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4660 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4661 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4662 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4663 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4664 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4665
4666 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4667 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4668 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4669 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4670 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4671 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4672 @end itemize
4673 @end deffn
4674
4675 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4676 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4677 for TCL scripting.
4678 @end deffn
4679
4680 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4681 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4682 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4683 @end deffn
4684
4685 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4686 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4687 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4688 initialization, too.
4689 @end deffn
4690
4691 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4692
4693 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4694 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4695 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4696 @end deffn
4697
4698 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4699 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4700 @end deffn
4701
4702 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4703 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4704 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4705 or set a new value @var{value}.
4706 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4707 @end deffn
4708
4709 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4710 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4711 @end deffn
4712
4713 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4714 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4715 value @var{value}.
4716
4717 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4718 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4719 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4720
4721 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4722 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4723 @end deffn
4724
4725 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4726 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4727 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4728 @end deffn
4729
4730 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4731 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4732 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4733 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4734 @end deffn
4735
4736 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4737 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4738
4739 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4740 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4741 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4742 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4743 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4744 for details.
4745
4746 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4747 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4748 the pattern:
4749 @example
4750 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4751 @end example
4752
4753 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4754 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4755 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4756 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4757 @example
4758 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4759 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4760 @end example
4761
4762 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4763 @example
4764 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4765 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4766 @end example
4767
4768 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4769 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4770
4771 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4772 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4773 example with a proper dap name:
4774 @example
4775 xxx.dap apcsw default
4776 @end example
4777 @end deffn
4778
4779 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4780 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4781 Disabled by default
4782 @end deffn
4783
4784
4785 @node CPU Configuration
4786 @chapter CPU Configuration
4787 @cindex GDB target
4788
4789 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4790 You can also access these targets without GDB
4791 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4792 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4793 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4794 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4795
4796 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4797 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4798
4799 @section Target List
4800 @cindex target, current
4801 @cindex target, list
4802
4803 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4804 where each member has a name.
4805 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4806 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4807 (plural!) command.
4808 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4809 look like with more than one:
4810 @verbatim
4811 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4812 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4813 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4814 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4815 @end verbatim
4816
4817 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4818 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4819 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4820 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4821 space seen by that current target.
4822 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4823 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4824 are examples; and there are many more.
4825
4826 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4827
4828 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4829 Returns the name of the current target.
4830 @end deffn
4831
4832 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4833 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4834 @example
4835 foreach t [target names] @{
4836 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4837 @}
4838 @end example
4839 @end deffn
4840
4841 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4842 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4843
4844 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4845 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4846 command names are singular.}
4847
4848 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4849 targets in a user friendly form.
4850
4851 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4852 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4853 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4854 @end deffn
4855
4856 @section Target CPU Types
4857 @cindex target type
4858 @cindex CPU type
4859
4860 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4861 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4862 when calling @command{target create}.
4863 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4864 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4865 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4866 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4867 what core-specific commands may be available
4868 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4869 and more.
4870
4871 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4872 since there's a command to list them.
4873
4874 @anchor{targettypes}
4875 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4876 Lists all supported target types.
4877 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4878
4879 @itemize @bullet
4880 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4881 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4882 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4883 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4884 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4885 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4886 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4887 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4888 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4889 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4890 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4891 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4892 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4893 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4894 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4895 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4896 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4897 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4898 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4899 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4900 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4901 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4902 @item @code{esp32s2} -- this is an Espressif SoC with single Xtensa core.
4903 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4904 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4905 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4906 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4907 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4908 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4909 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4910 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4911 support for new CPUs.
4912 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4913 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4914 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4915 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4916 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4917 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4918 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4919 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core (deprecated; would be removed in v0.13.0).
4920 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4921 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4922 @itemize @minus
4923 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4924 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4925 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4926 @end itemize
4927 And two debug interfaces cores:
4928 @itemize @minus
4929 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4930 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4931 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4932 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4933 @end itemize
4934 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4935 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4936 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4937 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4938 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4939 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4940 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4941 @end itemize
4942 @end deffn
4943
4944 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4945 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4946 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4947 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4948 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4949 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4950 reflect design generations;
4951 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4952 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4953
4954 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4955 @section Target Configuration
4956
4957 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4958 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4959 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4960 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4961 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4962
4963 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4964 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4965 optional parts.
4966 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4967 command, created as part of target creation.
4968
4969 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4970 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4971 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4972 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4973 to be much more board-specific.
4974 The key steps you use might look something like this
4975
4976 @example
4977 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4978 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4979 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4980 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4981 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4982 @end example
4983
4984 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4985 on-chip SRAM.
4986 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4987 writes to target memory;
4988 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4989 GDB memory checksumming;
4990 and more.
4991
4992 @quotation Warning
4993 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4994 inaccessible when application code
4995 (such as an operating system)
4996 enables or disables the MMU.
4997 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4998 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4999 easy access to other addresses needed.
5000 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
5001 @end quotation
5002
5003 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
5004 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
5005 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
5006 controllers.
5007 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
5008 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
5009 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
5010
5011 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
5012 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
5013 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
5014 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
5015 purposes including additional configuration.
5016
5017 @itemize @bullet
5018 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
5019 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
5020 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
5021 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
5022
5023 This name is also used to create the target object command,
5024 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
5025 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
5026 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
5027 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
5028 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
5029 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
5030
5031 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
5032 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
5033 @end itemize
5034 @end deffn
5035
5036 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
5037 The options accepted by this command may also be
5038 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
5039 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
5040 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
5041
5042 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
5043 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
5044 and changing its endianness.
5045
5046 @itemize @bullet
5047
5048 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
5049 used to access this target.
5050
5051 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
5052 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
5053 create and manage DAP instances.
5054
5055 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
5056 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
5057
5058 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
5059 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5060 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
5061 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
5062 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
5063 same event name assigns only one handler.
5064
5065 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
5066 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
5067
5068 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
5069 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
5070 @emph{it is not backed up.}
5071 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
5072 since performing a backup slows down operations.
5073 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
5074 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
5075
5076 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
5077 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
5078 or virtual address is being used.
5079
5080 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
5081 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
5082
5083 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
5084 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
5085 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
5086 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
5087 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
5088
5089 @anchor{rtostype}
5090 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
5091 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
5092 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
5093 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
5094 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
5095 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
5096
5097 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
5098 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
5099 access the target for debugging.
5100
5101 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
5102 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5103 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
5104 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
5105
5106 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
5107 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
5108 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
5109 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
5110 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
5111
5112 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
5113 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
5114 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
5115 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
5116 command @command{gdb_port}.
5117 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
5118
5119 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
5120 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
5121 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
5122 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
5123 @end itemize
5124 @end deffn
5125
5126 @section Other $target_name Commands
5127 @cindex object command
5128
5129 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
5130 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
5131
5132 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
5133 Once a button is created a button
5134 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
5135 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
5136 configure it like this:
5137
5138 @example
5139 # Create
5140 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
5141 # Modify
5142 .foobar configure -foreground blue
5143 # Query
5144 set x [.foobar cget -background]
5145 # Report
5146 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
5147 @end example
5148
5149 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
5150 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
5151
5152 @example
5153 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
5154 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
5155 @end example
5156
5157 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
5158
5159 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
5160 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
5161 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
5162 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
5163 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
5164 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
5165 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
5166 They are not otherwise documented here.
5167 @end deffn
5168
5169 @deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
5170 Set register values of the target.
5171
5172 @itemize
5173 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
5174 @end itemize
5175
5176 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
5177 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
5178
5179 @example
5180 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
5181 @end example
5182 @end deffn
5183
5184 @deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
5185 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
5186 of register names and values.
5187 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
5188 target, bypassing any caching.
5189
5190 @itemize
5191 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
5192 @end itemize
5193
5194 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
5195 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
5196
5197 @example
5198 get_reg @{pc sp@}
5199 @end example
5200 @end deffn
5201
5202 @deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
5203 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
5204 script.
5205
5206 @itemize
5207 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5208 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5209 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
5210 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5211 @end itemize
5212
5213 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
5214 memory at address 0x20000000:
5215
5216 @example
5217 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
5218 @end example
5219 @end deffn
5220
5221 @deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
5222 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
5223 script.
5224 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
5225
5226 @itemize
5227 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5228 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5229 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
5230 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5231 @end itemize
5232
5233 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
5234 memory at address 0x20000000:
5235
5236 @example
5237 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
5238 @end example
5239 @end deffn
5240
5241 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
5242 Each configuration parameter accepted by
5243 @command{$target_name configure}
5244 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
5245 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
5246 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
5247 There are a few special cases:
5248
5249 @itemize @bullet
5250 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
5251 event named @var{event_name}.
5252 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
5253 two parameters.
5254 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
5255 This is a special case because this is set using
5256 @command{target create} and can't be changed
5257 using @command{$target_name configure}.
5258 @end itemize
5259
5260 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
5261 all the targets you might use something like this:
5262
5263 @example
5264 foreach name [target names] @{
5265 set y [$name cget -endian]
5266 set z [$name cget -type]
5267 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
5268 $x $name $y $z]
5269 @}
5270 @end example
5271 @end deffn
5272
5273 @anchor{targetcurstate}
5274 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
5275 Displays the current target state:
5276 @code{debug-running},
5277 @code{halted},
5278 @code{reset},
5279 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5280 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5281 @end deffn
5282
5283 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5284 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5285 currently associated with this target.
5286 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5287 @end deffn
5288
5289 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5290 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5291 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5292 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5293 @end deffn
5294
5295 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5296 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5297 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5298 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5299 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5300 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5301 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5302 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5303 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5304 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5305 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5306 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5307 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5308 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
5309 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
5310 @end deffn
5311
5312 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5313 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5314 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5315 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5316 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5317 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5318 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5319 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5320 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5321 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5322 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5323 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5324 @end deffn
5325
5326 @anchor{targetevents}
5327 @section Target Events
5328 @cindex target events
5329 @cindex events
5330 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5331 For example:
5332 @itemize @bullet
5333 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5334 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5335 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5336 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5337 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5338 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5339 to set up system clocks or
5340 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5341 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5342 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5343 @end itemize
5344
5345 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5346 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5347 @command{target create ... -event}.
5348
5349 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5350 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5351 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5352
5353 @example
5354 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5355 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5356 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5357 @}
5358 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5359 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5360 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5361 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5362 @}
5363 @end example
5364
5365 The following target events are defined:
5366
5367 @itemize @bullet
5368 @item @b{debug-halted}
5369 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5370 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5371 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5372 @item @b{early-halted}
5373 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5374 @item @b{examine-start}
5375 @* Before target examine is called.
5376 @item @b{examine-end}
5377 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5378 @item @b{examine-fail}
5379 @* After target examine fails.
5380 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5381 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5382 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5383 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5384 connect GDB to running target.
5385 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5386 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5387 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5388 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5389 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5390 is in RAM or read only memory.
5391 Default is @code{halt}
5392 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5393 @* When GDB disconnects
5394 @item @b{gdb-end}
5395 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5396 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5397 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5398 @code{reset init})
5399 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5400 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5401 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5402 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5403 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5404 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5405 @item @b{gdb-start}
5406 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5407 @item @b{halted}
5408 @* The target has halted
5409 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5410 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5411 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5412 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5413 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5414 @item @b{reset-assert}
5415 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5416 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5417 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5418 it instead of asserting SRST.
5419 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5420 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5421 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5422 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5423 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5424 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5425 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5426 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5427 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5428 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5429 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5430 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5431 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5432 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5433 released on the scan chain.
5434 @item @b{reset-end}
5435 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5436 @item @b{reset-init}
5437 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5438 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5439
5440 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5441 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5442 multiplexing, and so on.
5443 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5444 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5445 @item @b{reset-start}
5446 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5447 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5448
5449 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5450 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5451 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5452 @item @b{resume-start}
5453 @* Before any target is resumed
5454 @item @b{resume-end}
5455 @* After all targets have resumed
5456 @item @b{resumed}
5457 @* Target has resumed
5458 @item @b{step-start}
5459 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5460 @item @b{step-end}
5461 @* After single-step has completed
5462 @item @b{trace-config}
5463 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5464 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5465 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5466 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5467 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5468 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5469 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5470 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5471 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5472 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5473 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5474 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5475 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5476 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5477 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5478 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5479 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5480 @end itemize
5481
5482 @quotation Note
5483 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5484 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5485 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5486 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5487 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5488 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5489 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5490 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5491 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5492 check if the core has changed status.
5493 @end quotation
5494
5495 @node Flash Commands
5496 @chapter Flash Commands
5497
5498 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5499 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5500 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5501 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5502 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5503 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5504 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5505 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5506 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5507
5508 Flash Steps:
5509 @enumerate
5510 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5511 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5512 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5513 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5514 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5515 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5516 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5517 @item GDB Flashing
5518 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5519 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5520 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5521 @end enumerate
5522
5523 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5524 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5525 so that it can't boot.
5526 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5527 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5528
5529 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5530 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5531 @cindex flash configuration
5532
5533 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5534 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5535 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5536 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5537 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5538 see the driver-specific documentation.
5539
5540 @itemize @bullet
5541 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5542 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5543 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5544 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5545 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5546 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5547 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5548 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5549 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5550 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5551 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5552 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5553 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5554 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5555 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5556 commands to the flash controller.
5557 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5558 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5559 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5560 for more information.
5561 @end itemize
5562 @quotation Note
5563 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5564 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5565 @end quotation
5566 @end deffn
5567
5568 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5569 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5570 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5571 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5572 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5573 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5574 @end deffn
5575
5576 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5577 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5578 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5579 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5580 @end deffn
5581
5582 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5583 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5584 depends on the flash type.
5585 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5586 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5587 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5588 but most don't bother.
5589 @end deffn
5590
5591 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5592
5593 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5594 begins.
5595
5596 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5597 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5598 until the programming session is finished.
5599
5600 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5601 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5602
5603 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5604
5605 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5606 @cindex flash erasing
5607 @cindex flash reading
5608 @cindex flash writing
5609 @cindex flash programming
5610 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5611
5612 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5613 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5614 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5615 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5616 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5617
5618 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5619 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5620 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5621 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5622 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5623
5624 @quotation Note
5625 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5626 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5627 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5628 back to a flash bank.
5629 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5630 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5631 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5632 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5633 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5634 @end quotation
5635
5636 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5637 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5638 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5639 disabled first.
5640 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5641 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5642 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5643
5644 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5645 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5646 up to and including @var{last}.
5647 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5648 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5649 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5650 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5651 @end deffn
5652
5653 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5654 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5655 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5656 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5657 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5658 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5659 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5660 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5661 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5662 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5663 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5664 before erase starts.
5665 @end deffn
5666
5667 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5668 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5669 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5670 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5671 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5672 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5673 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5674 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5675 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5676 before issuing this command.
5677 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5678 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5679 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5680 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5681 @end deffn
5682 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5683
5684 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5685 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5686 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5687 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5688 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5689 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5690 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5691 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5692 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5693 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5694 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5695 @end deffn
5696
5697 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5698 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5699 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5700 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5701 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5702 @end deffn
5703
5704 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5705 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5706 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5707 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5708 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5709 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5710 @end deffn
5711
5712 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5713 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5714 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5715 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5716 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5717 @end deffn
5718
5719 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5720 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5721 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5722 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5723 to the base address for each section in the image.
5724 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5725 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5726 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5727 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5728 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5729 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5730 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5731 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5732 each image section.
5733
5734 @quotation Warning
5735 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5736 data you want to preserve.
5737 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5738 sections might be erased with no notice.
5739 @itemize
5740 @item
5741 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5742 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5743 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5744 @item
5745 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5746 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5747 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5748 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5749 @end itemize
5750 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5751 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5752 @end quotation
5753
5754 @end deffn
5755
5756 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5757 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5758 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5759 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5760 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5761 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5762 ordinary memory reads.
5763 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5764 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5765 check for successful programming.
5766 @end deffn
5767
5768 @section Other Flash commands
5769 @cindex flash protection
5770
5771 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5772 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5773 and display that status.
5774 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5775 @end deffn
5776
5777 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5778 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5779 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5780
5781 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5782 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5783 and possibly stale information.
5784 @end deffn
5785
5786 @anchor{flashprotect}
5787 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5788 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5789 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5790 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5791 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5792 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5793 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5794 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5795 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5796 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5797 @end deffn
5798
5799 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5800 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5801 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5802 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5803 @end deffn
5804
5805 @anchor{program}
5806 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5807 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5808 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5809 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5810 @end deffn
5811
5812 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5813 @section Flash Driver List
5814 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5815 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5816 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5817
5818 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5819 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5820 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5821
5822 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5823
5824 @itemize
5825 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5826 @end itemize
5827
5828 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5829 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5830 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5831 @example
5832 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5833 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5834 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5835 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5836 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5837 @end example
5838 @end deffn
5839
5840 @subsection External Flash
5841
5842 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5843 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5844 @cindex CFI
5845 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5846 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5847 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5848 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5849 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5850 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5851 configure a bus and its timings), or
5852 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5853 on the flash chip.
5854 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5855 speed up operation.
5856
5857 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5858
5859 @itemize
5860 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5861 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5862 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5863 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5864 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5865 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5866 @end itemize
5867
5868 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5869 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5870
5871 @example
5872 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5873 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5874 @end example
5875
5876 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5877 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5878 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5879
5880 @example
5881 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5882 @end example
5883
5884 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5885 @end deffn
5886
5887 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5888 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5889 @cindex SPI
5890 @cindex jtagspi
5891 @cindex bscan_spi
5892 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5893 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5894 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5895 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5896 accessed through JTAG.
5897
5898 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5899 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5900 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5901 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5902 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5903 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5904
5905 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5906 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5907 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5908 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5909 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5910 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5911 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5912 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5913
5914 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5915 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5916 command, see below.
5917
5918 @itemize
5919 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5920 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5921 @var{USER1} instruction.
5922 @end itemize
5923
5924 @example
5925 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5926 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5927 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5928 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5929 @end example
5930
5931 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5932 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5933 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5934 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5935 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5936 @example
5937 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5938 @end example
5939 @end deffn
5940
5941 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5942 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5943 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5944 @example
5945 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5946 @end example
5947 @end deffn
5948
5949 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5950 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5951 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5952 @end deffn
5953 @end deffn
5954
5955 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5956 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5957 @cindex xcf
5958 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5959 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5960 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5961 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5962 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5963
5964 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5965 command accepts additional parameters:
5966 @itemize
5967 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5968 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5969 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5970 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5971 in master mode.
5972 @end itemize
5973 @example
5974 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5975 @end example
5976 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5977 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5978 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5979 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5980 dedicated sector.
5981 @end deffn
5982
5983 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5984 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5985 button.
5986 @example
5987 xcf configure 0
5988 @end example
5989 @end deffn
5990
5991 Additional driver notes:
5992 @itemize
5993 @item Only single revision supported.
5994 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5995 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5996 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5997 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5998 @end itemize
5999 @end deffn
6000
6001 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
6002 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
6003 @cindex SPIFI
6004 @cindex lpcspifi
6005 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
6006 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
6007 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
6008
6009 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
6010 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
6011 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
6012 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
6013 significantly reduce flash programming times.
6014
6015 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
6016 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
6017 are configured by the driver.
6018
6019 @example
6020 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6021 @end example
6022
6023 @end deffn
6024
6025 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
6026 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
6027 @cindex SMI
6028 @cindex stmsmi
6029 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
6030 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
6031 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
6032 SPI flash devices.
6033 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
6034 flash devices can be connected.
6035
6036 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
6037 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
6038 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
6039 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6040 the flash content.
6041
6042 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6043 to identify the memory bank.
6044 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
6045 flash size, are detected automatically.
6046
6047 @example
6048 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6049 @end example
6050
6051 @end deffn
6052
6053 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
6054 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
6055 @cindex QuadSPI
6056 @cindex OctoSPI
6057 @cindex stmqspi
6058 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
6059 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
6060 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
6061 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
6062 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
6063 mode is not.
6064
6065 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
6066 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
6067 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
6068 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
6069
6070 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
6071 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
6072 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
6073
6074 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
6075 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
6076 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
6077 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
6078 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
6079 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
6080
6081 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
6082 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
6083 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
6084 should be avoided.
6085
6086 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
6087 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
6088 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
6089 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
6090 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
6091 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
6092
6093 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
6094 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
6095 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
6096 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
6097 persist across openocd invocations.
6098
6099 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
6100 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
6101 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
6102 required (see 'set' command).
6103
6104 @example
6105 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
6106 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
6107 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
6108 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
6109 @end example
6110
6111 There are three specific commands
6112 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
6113 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
6114 chip specific write protection engaged.
6115 @end deffn
6116
6117 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6118 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
6119 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6120 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
6121 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
6122 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6123
6124 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
6125 which don't support an id command.
6126
6127 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
6128 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
6129 @end deffn
6130
6131 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6132 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
6133 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
6134 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
6135 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
6136
6137 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
6138 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
6139 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
6140 @var{resp_num} must be even.
6141
6142 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
6143
6144 To check basic communication settings, issue
6145 @example
6146 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6147 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6148 @end example
6149 for single flash mode or
6150 @example
6151 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6152 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6153 @end example
6154 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
6155
6156 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
6157 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
6158 need a dummy address, e.g.
6159 @example
6160 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
6161 @end example
6162 should return the status register contents.
6163
6164 @end deffn
6165
6166 @end deffn
6167
6168 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
6169 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
6170 Microcontroller platform.
6171
6172 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
6173 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
6174
6175 @example
6176 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
6177 @end example
6178
6179 @end deffn
6180
6181 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
6182 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
6183 @cindex ath79
6184 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
6185 chip selects.
6186 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
6187 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
6188 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
6189 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6190 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
6191 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
6192
6193 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6194 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
6195 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
6196 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
6197 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
6198 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
6199 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
6200 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
6201 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
6202 with the default CS0.
6203 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
6204 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
6205 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
6206
6207 @example
6208 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6209
6210 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
6211 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
6212 # distinguish the banks.
6213 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
6214 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
6215 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
6216 @end example
6217
6218 @end deffn
6219
6220 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
6221 @cindex Freedom E SPI
6222 @cindex fespi
6223
6224 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
6225
6226 @example
6227 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6228 @end example
6229 @end deffn
6230
6231 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
6232
6233 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
6234 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
6235 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6236 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
6237 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
6238 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
6239
6240 @example
6241 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6242 @end example
6243 @end deffn
6244
6245 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
6246 @cindex ambiqmicro
6247 @cindex apollo
6248 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
6249 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6250 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
6251 with the target using SWD.
6252
6253 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
6254 the device class of the MCU.
6255 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
6256 to set up the flash banks.
6257 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
6258 sizes of an Apollo chip.
6259
6260 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
6261 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
6262 and the second bank starts after the first.
6263
6264 @example
6265 # Flash bank 0
6266 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6267 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
6268 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
6269 $_TARGETNAME
6270 @end example
6271
6272 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
6273 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
6274 are available to the user.
6275
6276 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6277
6278 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6279 Erase entire bank.
6280 @end deffn
6281 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6282 Erase device pages.
6283 @end deffn
6284 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6285 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6286 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6287 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6288 the flash.
6289 @end deffn
6290 @end deffn
6291
6292 @anchor{at91samd}
6293 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6294 @cindex at91samd
6295 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6296 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6297
6298 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6299
6300 The devices have one flash bank:
6301
6302 @example
6303 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6304 @end example
6305
6306 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6307 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6308 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6309 processor to be halted.
6310 @end deffn
6311
6312 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6313 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6314 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6315 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6316 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6317 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6318
6319 @example
6320 at91samd set-security enable
6321 @end example
6322 @end deffn
6323
6324 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6325 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6326 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6327 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6328 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6329 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6330 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6331 in order to disable this feature.
6332
6333 @example
6334 at91samd eeprom
6335 at91samd eeprom 1024
6336 @end example
6337 @end deffn
6338
6339 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6340 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6341 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6342 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6343 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6344 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6345
6346 @example
6347 at91samd bootloader
6348 at91samd bootloader 16384
6349 @end example
6350 @end deffn
6351
6352 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6353 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6354 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6355 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6356 @end deffn
6357
6358 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6359 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6360 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6361 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6362 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6363 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6364 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6365 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6366
6367 @example
6368 # Read user row
6369 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6370 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6371 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6372 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6373 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6374 # byte unchanged
6375 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6376 @end example
6377 @end deffn
6378
6379 @end deffn
6380
6381 @anchor{at91sam3}
6382 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6383 @cindex at91sam3
6384 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6385 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6386 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6387 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6388 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6389 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6390 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6391 chips are confirmed.}
6392
6393 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6394 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6395 the following fixed locations:
6396
6397 @example
6398 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6399 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6400 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6401 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6402 @end example
6403
6404 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6405 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6406 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6407
6408 @itemize
6409 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6410 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6411 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6412 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6413 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6414 @end itemize
6415
6416 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6417
6418 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6419 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6420 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6421 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6422 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6423 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6424 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6425
6426 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6427 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6428 @end deffn
6429
6430 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6431 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6432 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6433 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6434 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6435 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6436 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6437 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6438 @end deffn
6439
6440 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6441 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6442 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6443 @end deffn
6444 @end deffn
6445
6446 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6447 @cindex at91sam4
6448 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6449 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6450 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6451 @end deffn
6452
6453 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6454 @cindex at91sam4l
6455 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6456 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6457 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6458
6459 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6460 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6461 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6462 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6463 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6464 @end deffn
6465 @end deffn
6466
6467 @anchor{atsame5}
6468 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6469 @cindex atsame5
6470 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6471 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6472 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6473
6474 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6475 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6476 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6477
6478 @example
6479 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6480 @end example
6481
6482 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6483 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6484 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6485 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6486 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6487 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6488
6489 @example
6490 atsame5 bootloader
6491 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6492 @end example
6493 @end deffn
6494
6495 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6496 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6497 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6498 processor to be halted.
6499 @end deffn
6500
6501 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6502 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6503 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6504 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6505 @end deffn
6506
6507 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6508 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6509 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6510 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6511 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6512 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6513 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6514 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6515
6516 @example
6517 # Read
6518 >atsame5 userpage
6519 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6520 # Write
6521 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6522 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6523 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6524 # bytes)
6525 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6526 @end example
6527 @end deffn
6528
6529 @end deffn
6530
6531 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6532 @cindex atsamv
6533 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6534 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6535 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6536
6537 @example
6538 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6539 @end example
6540
6541 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6542 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6543 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6544 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6545 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6546
6547 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6548 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6549 @end deffn
6550
6551 @end deffn
6552
6553 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6554 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6555 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6556 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6557 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6558
6559 @example
6560 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6561 @end example
6562
6563 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6564 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6565
6566 @itemize
6567 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6568 @item @var{banks}
6569 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6570 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6571 @item @var{pages_size}
6572 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6573 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6574 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6575 @end itemize
6576
6577 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6578 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6579 will be autoconfigured.
6580 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6581
6582 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6583 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6584 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6585 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6586 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6587
6588 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6589 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6590 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6591 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6592 are not truly general purpose).
6593 @quotation Note
6594 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6595 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6596 @end quotation
6597 @end deffn
6598 @end deffn
6599
6600 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6601 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6602 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6603 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6604 @end deffn
6605
6606 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6607 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6608 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6609 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6610
6611 @example
6612 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6613 @end example
6614
6615 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6616 each single sector one by one.
6617
6618 @example
6619 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6620 @end example
6621
6622 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6623 @end deffn
6624
6625 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6626 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6627 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6628 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6629 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6630 starts at address 0.
6631
6632 @example
6633 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6634 @end example
6635 @end deffn
6636
6637 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6638 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6639 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6640 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6641 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6642 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6643 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6644 and programming the serial flash.
6645
6646 @example
6647 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6648 @end example
6649 @end deffn
6650
6651 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6652 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6653 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6654 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6655 autoconfigures itself.
6656 @example
6657 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6658 @end example
6659 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6660 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6661 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6662 currently not supported.
6663 @example
6664 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6665 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6666 @end example
6667
6668 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6669 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6670 this via the following command:
6671 @example
6672 efm32 debuglock num
6673 @end example
6674 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6675 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6676 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6677 supported.}
6678 @end deffn
6679
6680 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6681 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6682 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6683 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6684 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6685 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6686
6687 @example
6688 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6689 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6690 @end example
6691
6692 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6693 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6697 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6698 is an uncommon operation.}
6699 @end deffn
6700 @end deffn
6701
6702 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6703 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6704 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6705 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6706 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6707 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6708 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6709
6710 @example
6711 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6712 @end example
6713 @end deffn
6714
6715 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6716 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6717 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6718 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6719 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6720 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6721 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6722 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6723 characters) ignored.
6724
6725 @example
6726 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6727 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6728 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6729 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6730 @end example
6731 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6732 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6733 @end deffn
6734
6735 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6736 @cindex kinetis
6737 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6738 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6739 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6740 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6741 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6742 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6743
6744 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6745 @itemize
6746 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6747 @end itemize
6748
6749 @example
6750 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6751 @end example
6752
6753 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6754 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6755 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6756 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6757 @end deffn
6758
6759 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6760 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6761 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6762 set by 'flash protect' command.
6763 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6764 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6765 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6766 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6767 with the rest of a flash image.
6768 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6769 @end deffn
6770
6771 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6772 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6773 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6774 @end deffn
6775
6776 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6777 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6778 and examine-fail event.
6779 @end deffn
6780
6781 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6782 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6783 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6787 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6788 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6789 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6790 command completes.
6791 @end deffn
6792
6793 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6794 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6795 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6796 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6797 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6798
6799 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6800 Program Partition command.
6801
6802 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6803 Reset the device after partition setting.
6804
6805 Show partition size:
6806 @example
6807 kinetis nvm_partition info
6808 @end example
6809
6810 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6811 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6812 @example
6813 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6814 @end example
6815
6816 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6817 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6818 @example
6819 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6820 @end example
6821 @end deffn
6822
6823 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6824 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6825 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6826 @end deffn
6827
6828 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6829 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6830 Command disables watchdog timer.
6831 @end deffn
6832 @end deffn
6833
6834 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6835 @cindex kinetis_ke
6836 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6837 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6838 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6839 autoconfigures itself.
6840 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6841
6842 @example
6843 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6844 @end example
6845
6846 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6847 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6848 @end deffn
6849
6850 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6851 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6852 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6853 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6854 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6855 @end deffn
6856
6857 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6858 Command disables watchdog timer.
6859 @end deffn
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6863 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6864 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6865 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6866 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6867
6868 @quotation Note
6869 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6870 driver:
6871 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6872 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6873 @end quotation
6874
6875 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6876 which must appear in the following order:
6877
6878 @itemize
6879 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6880 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6881 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6882 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6883 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6884 LPC43x[2357])
6885 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6886 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6887 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6888 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6889 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6890 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6891 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6892 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6893 at which the core is running
6894 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6895 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6896 @quotation Note
6897 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6898 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6899 However, if you do provide it,
6900 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6901 @end quotation
6902 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6903 ROM IAP entry point.
6904 @end itemize
6905
6906 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6907
6908 @example
6909 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6910 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6911 @end example
6912
6913 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6914 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6915 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6916 @end deffn
6917 @end deffn
6918
6919 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6920 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6921 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6922 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6923 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6924 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6925
6926 @example
6927 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6928 @end example
6929 @end deffn
6930
6931 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6932 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6933 from NXP.
6934
6935 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6936 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6937 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6938 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6939 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6940 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6941 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6942 you start the PLL.
6943
6944 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6945
6946 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6947 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6948 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6949
6950 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6951 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6952 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6953 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6954 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6955 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6956 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6957
6958 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6959 @example
6960 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6961 @end example
6962
6963 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6964 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6965 @code{flash banks} command.
6966
6967 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6968 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6969 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6970 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6971 a known signature.
6972 Example:
6973 @example
6974 lpc2900 signature 0
6975 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6976 @end example
6977 @end deffn
6978
6979 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6980 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6981 saves it to a file in binary format.
6982 Example:
6983 @example
6984 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6985 @end example
6986 @end deffn
6987
6988 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6989 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6990 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6991 command:
6992
6993 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6994 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6995 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6996 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6997
6998 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6999 Example:
7000 @example
7001 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
7002 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
7003 @end example
7004 @end deffn
7005
7006 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
7007 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
7008 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
7009 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
7010 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
7011 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
7012 912 bytes.
7013 @quotation Attention
7014 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7015 @end quotation
7016 Example:
7017 @example
7018 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
7019 @end example
7020 @end deffn
7021
7022 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
7023 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
7024 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
7025 after the next power cycle.
7026 @quotation Attention
7027 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7028 @end quotation
7029 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
7030 Example:
7031 @example
7032 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
7033 flash info 0
7034 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
7035 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7036 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
7037 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
7038 @end example
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
7042 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
7043 effective after the next power cycle.
7044 @quotation Attention
7045 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
7046 @end quotation
7047 Examples:
7048 @example
7049 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
7050 @end example
7051 @end deffn
7052 @end deffn
7053
7054 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
7055 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
7056 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
7057 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
7058
7059 @example
7060 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
7061 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
7062 @end example
7063
7064 @itemize @bullet
7065 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
7066 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
7067 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
7068 @end itemize
7069
7070 Example usage:
7071 @example
7072 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
7073 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
7074 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
7075 @} else @{
7076 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
7077 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
7078 @}
7079 @end example
7080 @end deffn
7081
7082 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
7083 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
7084 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
7085 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
7086 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
7087 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
7088
7089 @example
7090 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7091 @end example
7092
7093 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
7094 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
7095 only the main program flash.
7096
7097 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
7098 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
7099 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
7100 @end deffn
7101
7102 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
7103 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
7104 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
7105 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
7106
7107 To erase and program the BSL:
7108 @example
7109 msp432 bsl unlock
7110 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
7111 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
7112 msp432 bsl lock
7113 @end example
7114 @end deffn
7115 @end deffn
7116
7117 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
7118 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
7119 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7120 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
7121 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
7122 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
7123 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
7124 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
7125 also have division into regions: main and info.
7126 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
7127 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
7128
7129 @example
7130 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7131 @end example
7132
7133 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
7134
7135 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
7136 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
7137 @end deffn
7138
7139 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
7140 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
7141 @end deffn
7142
7143 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
7144 Erase all userflash including info region.
7145 @end deffn
7146
7147 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
7148 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7149 @end deffn
7150
7151 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
7152 Check sectors protect.
7153 @end deffn
7154
7155 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
7156 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7157 @end deffn
7158
7159 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
7160 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
7161 @end deffn
7162
7163 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
7164 Configure external memory interface for boot.
7165 @end deffn
7166
7167 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
7168 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
7172 Show information about flash driver.
7173 @end deffn
7174
7175 @end deffn
7176
7177 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
7178 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
7179 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
7180 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
7181 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
7182
7183 @example
7184 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7185 @end example
7186 @end deffn
7187
7188 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
7189 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
7190 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
7191 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
7192 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
7193 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
7194 - ACL).
7195
7196 @example
7197 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7198 @end example
7199
7200 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
7201
7202 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
7203 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
7204 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
7205 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
7206 code.
7207 @end deffn
7208
7209 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
7210 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
7211 @end deffn
7212
7213 @end deffn
7214
7215 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
7216 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
7217 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
7218
7219 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
7220 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
7221 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
7222 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
7223
7224 @example
7225 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7226 @end example
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
7230 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
7231 and integrate flash memory.
7232
7233 @example
7234 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7235 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7236 @end example
7237
7238 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
7239 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
7240 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
7241 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
7242 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
7243 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
7244 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
7245 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
7246 @end deffn
7247 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
7248 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
7249 This will remove any Code Protection.
7250 @end deffn
7251 @end deffn
7252
7253 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
7254 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
7255 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
7256 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7257 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7258
7259 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
7260 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
7261
7262 @example
7263 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7264 @end example
7265
7266 psoc4-specific commands
7267 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
7268 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
7269
7270 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
7271 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
7272
7273 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
7274 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
7275 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7276
7277 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7278 @end deffn
7279
7280 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7281 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7282
7283 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7284 @end deffn
7285 @end deffn
7286
7287 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7288 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7289 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7290 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7291 apart from the base address.
7292
7293 @example
7294 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7295 @end example
7296
7297 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7298 @quotation Attention
7299 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7300 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7301 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7302 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7303 @end quotation
7304
7305 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7306
7307 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7308 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7309 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7310 @end deffn
7311 @end deffn
7312
7313 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7314 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7315 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7316 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7317 apart from the base address.
7318
7319 @example
7320 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7321 $_TARGETNAME
7322 @end example
7323 @end deffn
7324
7325 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7326 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7327 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7328 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7329
7330 @example
7331 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7332 @end example
7333
7334 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7335
7336 @itemize
7337 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7338 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7339 @end itemize
7340
7341 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7342
7343 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7344 @quotation Attention
7345 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7346 after successful write.
7347 @end quotation
7348 @end deffn
7349
7350 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7351 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7352 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7353 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7354
7355 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7356 @itemize @bullet
7357 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7358 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7359 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7360 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7361 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7362 row size: 512 bytes.
7363 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7364 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7365 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7366 operation will erase row automatically.
7367 @end itemize
7368
7369 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7370 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7371
7372 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7373
7374 @example
7375 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7376 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7377 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7378 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7379 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7380 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7381 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7382 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7383 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7384 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7385 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7386 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7387
7388 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7389 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7390 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7391 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7392 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7393 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7394 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7395 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7396 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7397 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7398 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7399 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7400 @end example
7401
7402 psoc6-specific commands
7403 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7404 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7405 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7406 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7407 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7408 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7409 @end deffn
7410
7411 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7412 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7413 by @command{flash banks}.
7414 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7415 @end deffn
7416 @end deffn
7417
7418 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7419 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7420 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7421 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7422 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7423
7424 @example
7425 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7426 @end example
7427 @end deffn
7428
7429 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7430 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7431 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7432 and SWD interface.
7433 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7434 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7435
7436 @example
7437 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7438 @end example
7439
7440 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7441
7442 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7443 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7444 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7448 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7449 @end deffn
7450 @end deffn
7451
7452 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7453 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7454 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7455 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7456 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7457
7458 @example
7459 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7460 @end example
7461
7462 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7463 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7464 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7465 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7466 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7467 disabled.
7468
7469 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7470 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7471 @quotation Warning
7472 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7473 applied to all of them.
7474 @end quotation
7475 @end deffn
7476 @end deffn
7477
7478 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7479 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7480 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7481 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7482 The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
7483 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7484 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7485
7486 @example
7487 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7488 @end example
7489
7490 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7491 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7492 the flash driver.
7493
7494 @example
7495 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7496 @end example
7497
7498 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7499 as per the following example.
7500 @example
7501 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7502 @end example
7503
7504 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7505
7506 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7507 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7508 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7509 @end deffn
7510
7511 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7512 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7513 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7514 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7515 @end deffn
7516
7517 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7518 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7519 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7520 @end deffn
7521
7522 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7523 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7524 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7525 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7526 @end deffn
7527
7528 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7529 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7530 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7531 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7532 @end deffn
7533
7534 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7535 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7536 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7537 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7538 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7539 @end deffn
7540 @end deffn
7541
7542 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7543 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7544 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7545 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7546 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7547
7548 @example
7549 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7550 @end example
7551
7552 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7553 as per the following example.
7554 @example
7555 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7556 @end example
7557
7558 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7559 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7560 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7561 @end deffn
7562
7563 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7564 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7565 the flash driver.
7566
7567 @example
7568 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7569 @end example
7570
7571 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7572
7573 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7574 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7575 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7579 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7580 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7581 @end deffn
7582
7583 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7584 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7585 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7586 @end deffn
7587
7588 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7589 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7590 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7594 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7595 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7596 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7597 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7598 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7602 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7603 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7604 @end deffn
7605 @end deffn
7606
7607 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7608 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7609 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7610 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7611 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7612
7613 @example
7614 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7615 @end example
7616
7617 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7618 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7619 the flash driver.
7620
7621 @example
7622 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7623 @end example
7624
7625 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7626
7627 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7628 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7629 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7633 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7634 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7638 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7639 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7640 @end deffn
7641
7642 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7643 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7644 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7645 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7646 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7647
7648 Example usage:
7649 @example
7650 # read OPTSR_CUR
7651 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7652 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7653 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7654 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7655 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7656 @end example
7657 @end deffn
7658
7659 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7660 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7661 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7662 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7663 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7664 will be touched).
7665
7666 Example usage:
7667 @example
7668 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7669 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7670 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7671 @end example
7672 @end deffn
7673 @end deffn
7674
7675 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7676 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7677 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7678 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7679 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7680
7681 @example
7682 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7683 @end example
7684
7685 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7686 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7687 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7688 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7689 second bank.
7690
7691 @example
7692 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7693 @end example
7694
7695 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7696
7697 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7698 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7699 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7700 @end deffn
7701
7702 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7703 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7704 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7705 @end deffn
7706
7707 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7708 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7709 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7710 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7711 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7712 @end deffn
7713 @end deffn
7714
7715 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7716 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7717 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7718 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7719 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7720 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7721
7722 @example
7723 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7724 @end example
7725
7726 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7727 as per the following example.
7728 @example
7729 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7730 @end example
7731
7732 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7733 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7734 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7735 @end deffn
7736
7737 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7738 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7739 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7740 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7741
7742 @example
7743 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7744 @end example
7745
7746 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7747
7748 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7749 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7750 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7751
7752 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7753 @end deffn
7754
7755 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7756 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7757 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7758
7759 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7760 @end deffn
7761
7762 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7763 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7764 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7765 @end deffn
7766
7767 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7768 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7769 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7770 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7771
7772 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7773 @example
7774 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7775 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7776 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7777 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7778 @end example
7779
7780 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7781 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7782 @end deffn
7783
7784 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7785 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7786 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7787 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7788 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7789
7790 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7791
7792 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7793 @example
7794 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7795 @end example
7796
7797 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7798 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7799 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7800 @end deffn
7801
7802 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7803 List the protected areas using WRP.
7804 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7805 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7806 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7807
7808 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7809 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7810 in single or dual-banks mode.
7811 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7812 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7813
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7817 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7818 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7819 @end deffn
7820
7821 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7822 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7823 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7824 the TrustZone status.
7825 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7826 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7827 @end deffn
7828 @end deffn
7829
7830 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7831 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7832 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7833 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7834 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7835
7836 @example
7837 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7838 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7839 @end example
7840
7841 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7842 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7843 for the specified flash bank.
7844 @end deffn
7845 @end deffn
7846
7847 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7848 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7849 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7850 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7851 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7852
7853 @example
7854 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7855 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7856 @end example
7857
7858 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7859 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7860 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7861
7862 @itemize @bullet
7863 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7864 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7865 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7866 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7867 @end itemize
7868 @end deffn
7869
7870 @end deffn
7871
7872 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7873 @cindex str9xpec
7874
7875 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7876 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7877 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7878 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7879
7880 Here is some background info to help
7881 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7882 the str9:
7883 @enumerate
7884 @item
7885 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7886 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7887 @item
7888 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7889 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7890 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7891 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7892 @end enumerate
7893
7894 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7895 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7896 configured for flash bank 0.
7897 @example
7898 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7899 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7900 adapter assert srst
7901 # turn off target polling
7902 poll off
7903 # disable str9 core
7904 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7905 # read option bytes
7906 str9xpec options_read 0
7907 # re-enable str9 core
7908 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7909 poll on
7910 reset halt
7911 @end example
7912 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7913 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7914 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7915 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7916
7917 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7918
7919 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7920 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7921 @end deffn
7922
7923 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7924 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7925 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7926 @end deffn
7927
7928 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7929 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7930 erase the device.
7931 @end deffn
7932
7933 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7934 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7935 @end deffn
7936
7937 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7938 Configure str9 boot bank.
7939 @end deffn
7940
7941 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7942 Configure str9 lvd source.
7943 @end deffn
7944
7945 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7946 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7947 @end deffn
7948
7949 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7950 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7951 @end deffn
7952
7953 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7954 Read str9 option bytes.
7955 @end deffn
7956
7957 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7958 Write str9 option bytes.
7959 @end deffn
7960
7961 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7962 unlock str9 device.
7963 @end deffn
7964
7965 @end deffn
7966
7967 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7968 @cindex swm050
7969 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7970
7971 @example
7972 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7973 @end example
7974
7975 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7976
7977 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7978 Erases the entire flash bank.
7979 @end deffn
7980
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983
7984 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7985 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7986 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7987 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7988
7989 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7990
7991 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7992 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7993 @end deffn
7994
7995 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7996 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7997 @end deffn
7998
7999 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
8000 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
8001 the flash clock.
8002 @end deffn
8003 @end deffn
8004
8005 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
8006 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
8007 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
8008 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
8009 correct bank config.
8010
8011 @example
8012 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
8013 @end example
8014 @end deffn
8015
8016 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
8017 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8018 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8019 @end deffn
8020
8021 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
8022 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8023 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8024
8025 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
8026
8027 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
8028 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
8029 @end deffn
8030
8031 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
8032 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
8033 @end deffn
8034
8035 @end deffn
8036
8037 @section NAND Flash Commands
8038 @cindex NAND
8039
8040 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
8041 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
8042 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
8043
8044 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
8045 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
8046 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
8047 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
8048 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
8049 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
8050
8051 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
8052 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
8053 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
8054 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
8055 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
8056 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
8057 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
8058 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
8059 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
8060 with techniques such as wear leveling.
8061
8062 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
8063 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
8064 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
8065 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
8066 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
8067 every 512 bytes of data.
8068
8069 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
8070 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
8071 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
8072 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
8073 ECC mode is used.
8074
8075 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
8076 @enumerate
8077 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
8078 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
8079 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
8080 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
8081 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
8082 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
8083 to access that device.
8084 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
8085 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
8086 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
8087 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
8088 de-brick a board.
8089 @end enumerate
8090
8091 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
8092 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
8093 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
8094 are only 32 bits wide.
8095 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
8096 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
8097 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
8098 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
8099
8100 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
8101 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
8102 @cindex NAND configuration
8103
8104 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
8105 plus some additional configuration that's done after
8106 OpenOCD has initialized.
8107
8108 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
8109 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
8110 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
8111 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
8112 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
8113 they were a single (larger) device.
8114 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
8115 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
8116
8117 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
8118 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
8119 configuration files, not interactively.
8120
8121 @itemize @bullet
8122 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
8123 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
8124 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
8125 associated with the NAND device being declared.
8126 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
8127 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
8128 commands to the NAND controller.
8129 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
8130 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
8131 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
8132 for more information.
8133 @end itemize
8134 @end deffn
8135
8136 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
8137 Prints a summary of each device declared
8138 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
8139 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
8140 @example
8141 > nand list
8142 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8143 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8144 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8145 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8146 >
8147 @end example
8148 @end deffn
8149
8150 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
8151 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
8152 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
8153 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8154 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
8155 it with most other NAND commands.
8156 @end deffn
8157
8158 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
8159
8160 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
8161 @cindex NAND reading
8162 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
8163 starting at the specified offset.
8164 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8165
8166 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8167 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8168
8169 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
8170 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
8171 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
8172
8173 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
8174 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
8175 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
8176 method which handled that error correction.
8177
8178 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
8179 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
8180 @itemize @bullet
8181 @item no oob_* parameter
8182 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
8183 @item @code{oob_raw}
8184 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
8185 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
8186 spare areas associated with each data page.
8187 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
8188 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
8189 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
8190 @item @code{oob_only}
8191 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
8192 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
8193 spare areas associated with each data page.
8194 @end itemize
8195 @end deffn
8196
8197 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
8198 @cindex NAND erasing
8199 @cindex NAND programming
8200 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
8201 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
8202 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8203 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8204 If those parameters are not specified,
8205 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
8206 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8207
8208 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
8209 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
8210 block marker.
8211 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
8212 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
8213 @end deffn
8214
8215 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
8216 @cindex NAND writing
8217 @cindex NAND programming
8218 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
8219 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
8220 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
8221 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8222
8223 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8224 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8225
8226 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8227 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
8228 past the end of the device.
8229 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
8230 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
8231 if that's being written.)
8232
8233 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
8234 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
8235 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
8236
8237 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
8238 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
8239 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
8240 @itemize @bullet
8241 @item no oob_* parameter
8242 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8243 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
8244 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8245 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
8246 with hardware-computed ECC data.
8247 @item @code{oob_only}
8248 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
8249 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
8250 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
8251 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
8252 @item @code{oob_raw}
8253 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
8254 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
8255 un-altered OOB.
8256 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8257 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
8258 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
8259 @item @code{oob_softecc}
8260 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8261 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
8262 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
8263 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8264 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8265 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
8266 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8267 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
8268 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
8269 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8270 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8271 @end itemize
8272 @end deffn
8273
8274 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
8275 @cindex NAND verification
8276 @cindex NAND programming
8277 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8278 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8279 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8280
8281 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8282 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8283
8284 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8285 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8286 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8287 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8288 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8289
8290 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8291 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8292 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8293
8294 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8295 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8296 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8297 be removed in a future release.
8298 @end deffn
8299
8300 @subsection Other NAND commands
8301 @cindex NAND other commands
8302
8303 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8304 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8305 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8306 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8307 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8308 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8309 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8310 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8311
8312 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8313 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8314 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8315 @end deffn
8316
8317 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8318 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8319 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8320 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8321 status for each block.
8322 @end deffn
8323
8324 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8325 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8326 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8327
8328 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8329 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8330 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8331 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8332 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8333
8334 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8335 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8336 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8337 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8338 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8339 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8340 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8341 @end deffn
8342
8343 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8344 @subsection NAND Driver List
8345 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8346 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8347 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8348
8349 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8350 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8351 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8352 address of the ECC controller.
8353 @example
8354 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8355 @end example
8356 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8357 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8358 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8359 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8360 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8361 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8362 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8363 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8364 @end deffn
8365 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8366 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8367 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8368 @end deffn
8369
8370 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8371 properly configured for input or output.
8372 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8373 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8374 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8375 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8376 @end deffn
8377 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8378 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8379 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8380 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8381 @end deffn
8382 @end deffn
8383
8384 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8385 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8386 chips from Texas Instruments.
8387 It takes three extra parameters:
8388 address of the NAND chip;
8389 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8390 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8391 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8392 @example
8393 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8394 @end example
8395 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8396 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8397 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8398 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8399 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8400 @end deffn
8401
8402 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8403 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8404 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8405 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8406 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8407 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8408 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8412 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8413 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8414 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8415 @end deffn
8416 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8417
8418 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8419 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8420 should work for this chip as well.
8421 @end deffn
8422
8423 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8424 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8425 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8426 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8427 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8428 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8429 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8430 @example
8431 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8432 @end example
8433 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8434 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8435 without parameter query status.
8436 @end deffn
8437 @end deffn
8438
8439 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8440 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8441 parameter: the address of the controller.
8442 @example
8443 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8444 @end example
8445 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8446 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8447 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8448 change any behavior.
8449 @end deffn
8450
8451 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8452 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8453 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8454 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8455 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8456 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8457 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8458 specialized commands.
8459 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8460 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8461 change any behavior.
8462 @end deffn
8463
8464 @node Flash Programming
8465 @chapter Flash Programming
8466
8467 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8468 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8469 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8470
8471 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8472 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8473
8474 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8475 @enumerate
8476 @item 'init' is executed.
8477 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8478 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8479 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8480 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8481 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8482 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8483 @end enumerate
8484
8485 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8486
8487 @example
8488 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8489 # are optional parameters
8490 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8491 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8492
8493 # binary files need the flash address passing
8494 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8495 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8496 @end example
8497
8498 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8499 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8500 @cindex PLD
8501 @cindex FPGA
8502
8503 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8504 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8505 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8506 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8507 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8508 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8509 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8510
8511 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8512
8513 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8514 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8515 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8516
8517 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8518 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8519
8520 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8521 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8522 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8523 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8524 behavior.
8525 @end deffn
8526
8527 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8528 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8529 @end deffn
8530
8531 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8532 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8533 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8534 @end deffn
8535
8536 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8537
8538 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8539 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8540 that particular type of PLD.
8541
8542 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8543 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8544 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8545
8546 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8547 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8548 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8549
8550 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8551 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8552 for FPGA @var{num}.
8553 @end deffn
8554 @end deffn
8555
8556 @node General Commands
8557 @chapter General Commands
8558 @cindex commands
8559
8560 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8561 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8562 commands are documented elsewhere.
8563
8564 Intent:
8565 @itemize @bullet
8566 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8567 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8568 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8569 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8570
8571 @item @b{From the human}
8572 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8573 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8574
8575 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8576 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8577 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8578
8579 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8580 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8581 port is 5555.
8582 @end itemize
8583
8584
8585 @section Server Commands
8586
8587 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8588 Exits the current telnet session.
8589 @end deffn
8590
8591 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8592 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8593 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8594 Not every command provides helptext.
8595
8596 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8597 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8598 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8599 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8600 @end deffn
8601
8602 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8603 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8604 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8605 containing @var{string}.
8606 Not every command provides helptext.
8607 @end deffn
8608
8609 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8610 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8611 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8612 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8613 Useful in connection with script files
8614 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8615 @end deffn
8616
8617 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8618 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8619 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8620 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8621
8622 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
8623 will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
8624
8625 It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
8626 set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
8627 @example
8628 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
8629 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
8630 @end example
8631 The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
8632 in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
8633 fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
8634 will proceed to quit.
8635 @end deffn
8636
8637 @anchor{debuglevel}
8638 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8639 @cindex message level
8640 Display debug level.
8641 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8642 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8643 Level 0 is error messages only;
8644 level 1 adds warnings;
8645 level 2 adds informational messages;
8646 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8647 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8648 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8649 the command line along with the location of that log
8650 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8651 @xref{Running}.
8652 @end deffn
8653
8654 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8655 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8656 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8657 @example
8658 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8659 @end example
8660 @end deffn
8661
8662 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8663 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8664 the default log output channel is stderr.
8665 @end deffn
8666
8667 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8668 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8669 @end deffn
8670
8671 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8672 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8673 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8674 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8675 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8676 @end deffn
8677
8678 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8679 @section Target State handling
8680 @cindex reset
8681 @cindex halt
8682 @cindex target initialization
8683
8684 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8685 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8686 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8687 a current target which is used to perform the
8688 various operations. The current target may be changed
8689 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8690 target which should become current.
8691
8692 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8693 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8694 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8695 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8696 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8697
8698 @emph{With no arguments}:
8699 list all available registers for the current target,
8700 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8701 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8702 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8703 are flagged as such.
8704
8705 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8706 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8707 bypassing any internal cache.
8708
8709 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8710 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8711 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8712 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8713 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8714 relevant module will flush such values.
8715
8716 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8717 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8718
8719 @example
8720 > reg
8721 ===== ARM registers
8722 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8723 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8724 (2) r2 (/32)
8725 ...
8726 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8727 >
8728 @end example
8729 @end deffn
8730
8731 @deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
8732 Set register values of the target.
8733
8734 @itemize
8735 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
8736 @end itemize
8737
8738 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
8739 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
8740
8741 @example
8742 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
8743 @end example
8744 @end deffn
8745
8746 @deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
8747 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
8748 of register names and values.
8749 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
8750 target, bypassing any caching.
8751
8752 @itemize
8753 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
8754 @end itemize
8755
8756 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
8757 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
8758
8759 @example
8760 get_reg @{pc sp@}
8761 @end example
8762 @end deffn
8763
8764 @deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
8765 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
8766 script.
8767
8768 @itemize
8769 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8770 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8771 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
8772 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8773 @end itemize
8774
8775 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
8776 memory at address 0x20000000:
8777
8778 @example
8779 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
8780 @end example
8781 @end deffn
8782
8783 @deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
8784 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
8785 script.
8786 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
8787
8788 @itemize
8789 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8790 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8791 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
8792 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8793 @end itemize
8794
8795 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
8796 memory at address 0x20000000:
8797
8798 @example
8799 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
8800 @end example
8801 @end deffn
8802
8803 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8804 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8805 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8806 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8807 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8808 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8809 (and enter debug mode).
8810 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8811
8812 @quotation Warning
8813 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8814 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8815 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8816 power mode by gating the core clock;
8817 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8818
8819 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8820 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8821 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8822 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8823 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8824 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8825
8826 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8827 work with a JTAG debugger.
8828 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8829 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8830 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8831 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8832 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8833 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8834 @end quotation
8835
8836 @end deffn
8837
8838 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8839 Resume the target at its current code position,
8840 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8841 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8842 @end deffn
8843
8844 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8845 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8846 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8847 @end deffn
8848
8849 @anchor{resetcommand}
8850 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8851 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8852 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8853 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8854 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8855 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8856 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8857
8858 The optional parameter specifies what should
8859 happen after the reset.
8860 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8861 The other options will not work on all systems.
8862 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8863
8864 @itemize @minus
8865 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8866 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8867 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8868 @end itemize
8869 @end deffn
8870
8871 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8872 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8873 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8874 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8875 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8876 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8877 state.
8878 @end deffn
8879
8880 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8881 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8882 Set values of reset signals.
8883 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8884 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8885 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8886 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8887
8888 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8889 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8890 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8891 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8892 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8893 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8894 the signal will not be modified.
8895
8896 @quotation Note
8897 TRST is specially handled.
8898 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8899 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8900 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8901 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8902 instead of the TRST signal.
8903 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8904 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8905 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8906 with handlers for that event.
8907 @end quotation
8908 @end deffn
8909
8910 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8911 @section Memory access commands
8912 @cindex memory access
8913
8914 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8915 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8916 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8917 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8918
8919 @enumerate
8920 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8921 to change the current target.
8922 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8923 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8924 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8925 @end enumerate
8926
8927 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8928 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8929 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8930 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8931 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8932 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8933 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8934 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8935 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8936 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8937 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8938 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8939 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8940 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
8941 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8945 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8946 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8947 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8948 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8949 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8950 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8951 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8952 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8953 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8954 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8955 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8956 @end deffn
8957
8958 @anchor{imageaccess}
8959 @section Image loading commands
8960 @cindex image loading
8961 @cindex image dumping
8962
8963 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8964 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8965 binary file named @var{filename}.
8966 @end deffn
8967
8968 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8969 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8970 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8971 @end deffn
8972
8973 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8974 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8975 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8976 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8977 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8978 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8979 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8980 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8981 separately.
8982 @end deffn
8983
8984 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8985 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8986 The file format may optionally be specified
8987 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8988 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8989 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8990 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8991 @example
8992 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8993 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8994 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8995 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
8996 $address $length
8997 @}
8998 @end example
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
9002 Displays image section sizes and addresses
9003 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
9004 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
9005 The file format may optionally be specified
9006 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9007 @end deffn
9008
9009 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9010 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9011 The file format may optionally be specified
9012 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9013 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
9014 @end deffn
9015
9016 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9017 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9018 The file format may optionally be specified
9019 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9020 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
9021 @end deffn
9022
9023
9024 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
9025 @cindex breakpoint
9026 @cindex watchpoint
9027
9028 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
9029 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
9030 watchpoints.
9031 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
9032
9033 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
9034 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
9035 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
9036 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9037 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
9038 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
9039
9040 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
9041 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
9042 @end deffn
9043
9044 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
9045 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
9046 @end deffn
9047
9048 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
9049 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
9050 @end deffn
9051
9052 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
9053 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
9054 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9055 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
9056 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
9057 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
9058 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
9059 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
9060 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
9061 @end deffn
9062
9063
9064 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
9065
9066 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
9067 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
9068 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
9069 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
9070 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
9071 running, can be used.
9072 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
9073 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
9074 applicable because of real-time constraints.
9075
9076 @quotation Note
9077 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
9078 @end quotation
9079
9080 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
9081 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
9082 communication, respectively.
9083
9084 @quotation Note
9085 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
9086 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
9087 example.
9088 @end quotation
9089
9090 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
9091 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
9092 of TCP/IP connections.
9093
9094 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
9095 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
9096 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
9097 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
9098 @var{size} bytes.
9099 @end deffn
9100
9101 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
9102 Start RTT.
9103 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
9104 @end deffn
9105
9106 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
9107 Stop RTT.
9108 @end deffn
9109
9110 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
9111 Display the polling interval.
9112 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
9113 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
9114 checked for new data.
9115 @end deffn
9116
9117 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
9118 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
9119 @end deffn
9120
9121 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
9122 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
9123 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
9124 @end deffn
9125
9126 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
9127 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
9128 @end deffn
9129
9130 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
9131 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
9132 @end deffn
9133
9134 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
9135 on the target device.
9136
9137 @example
9138 resume
9139
9140 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
9141 rtt start
9142
9143 rtt server start 9090 0
9144 @end example
9145
9146 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
9147 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
9148 TCP/IP port 9090.
9149
9150
9151 @section Misc Commands
9152
9153 @cindex profiling
9154 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
9155 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
9156 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
9157 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
9158 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
9159 limit the address range.
9160 @end deffn
9161
9162 @deffn {Command} {version}
9163 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
9164 @end deffn
9165
9166 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
9167 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
9168 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
9169 @end deffn
9170
9171 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9172 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
9173 @end deffn
9174
9175 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9176 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
9177 @end deffn
9178
9179 @node Architecture and Core Commands
9180 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
9181 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
9182 @cindex Core Specific Commands
9183
9184 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
9185 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
9186 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
9187 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
9188
9189 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
9190 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
9191 @cindex tracing
9192 @cindex ETM
9193 @cindex ETB
9194
9195 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
9196 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
9197 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
9198
9199 @itemize
9200 @item
9201 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
9202 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
9203 supports such an interface.
9204 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
9205 and trace port support.)
9206 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
9207 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
9208 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
9209 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
9210 in the board-specific configuration file.
9211 @item
9212 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
9213 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
9214 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
9215 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
9216 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
9217 @end itemize
9218
9219 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
9220
9221 @quotation Issues
9222 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
9223 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
9224
9225 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
9226 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
9227 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
9228 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
9229 dummy trace port driver}.
9230
9231 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
9232 as well as tracing only during specific states
9233 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
9234
9235 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
9236 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
9237 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
9238 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
9239 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
9240
9241 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
9242 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
9243 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
9244 this original style of JTAG access.
9245 @end quotation
9246
9247 @subsection ETM Configuration
9248 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
9249
9250 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
9251 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
9252 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
9253
9254 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
9255 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
9256 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
9257 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
9258 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
9259 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
9260 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
9261 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
9262 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
9263
9264 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
9265 or @option{demultiplexed}.
9266 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
9267
9268 @quotation Warning
9269 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
9270 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
9271 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
9272 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
9273 @end quotation
9274
9275 @quotation Note
9276 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
9277 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
9278 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
9279 what CPU activities are traced.
9280 @end quotation
9281 @end deffn
9282
9283 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
9284 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
9285 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
9286 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
9287 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
9291 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
9292 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
9293 Did trace data overflow?
9294 Was it triggered?
9295 @end deffn
9296
9297 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
9298 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
9299 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
9300 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
9301 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
9302
9303 @itemize
9304 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
9305 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
9306 The value is one of
9307 @option{none} (save nothing),
9308 @option{data} (save data),
9309 @option{address} (save addresses),
9310 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
9311 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
9312 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
9313 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
9314 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
9315 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
9316 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
9317 trace stream without an image of the code.
9318 @end itemize
9319 @end deffn
9320
9321 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9322 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
9323 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
9324 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
9325 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
9326
9327 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
9328 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
9329 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
9330 @end deffn
9331
9332 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
9333
9334 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
9335 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
9336 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
9337
9338 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
9339 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
9340 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
9341 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
9342 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
9343 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
9344 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
9345
9346 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
9347
9348 @itemize
9349 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9350 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9351 for instruction access within that function's body.
9352 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9353 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9354 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9355 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9356 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9357 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9358 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9359 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9360 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9361 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9362 @item @emph{... more}
9363 @end itemize
9364
9365 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9366 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9367
9368 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9369 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9370 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9371 @end deffn
9372
9373 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9374 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9375 @end deffn
9376
9377 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9378 Opens an image file.
9379 @end deffn
9380
9381 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9382 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9383 @end deffn
9384
9385 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9386 Starts trace data collection.
9387 @end deffn
9388
9389 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9390 Stops trace data collection.
9391 @end deffn
9392
9393 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9394 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9395
9396 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9397
9398 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9399 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9400 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9401 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9402 any trace data collection.}
9403 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9404 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9405 @end deffn
9406 @end deffn
9407
9408 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9409 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9410 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9411 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9412 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9413 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9414 @end deffn
9415 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9416 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9417 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9418 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9419 trace trigger becomes active.
9420
9421 @itemize
9422 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9423 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9424 afterwards.
9425 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9426 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9427 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9428 what caused that event to happen.
9429 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9430 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9431 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9432 how the event caused trouble.
9433 @end itemize
9434 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9435 @end deffn
9436
9437 @end deffn
9438
9439 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9440 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9441 @cindex CTI
9442
9443 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9444 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9445 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9446 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9447 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9448 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9449
9450 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9451 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9452 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9453 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9454 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9455 including additional configuration.
9456 @end deffn
9457
9458 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9459 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9460 @end deffn
9461
9462 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9463 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9464 @end deffn
9465
9466 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9467 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9468 @end deffn
9469
9470 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9471 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9472 @end deffn
9473
9474 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9475 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9476 @end deffn
9477
9478 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9479 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9480 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9481 @end deffn
9482
9483 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9484 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9485 of the CTI.
9486 @end deffn
9487
9488 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9489 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9490 useful in TCL scripting.
9491 @end deffn
9492
9493 @section Generic ARM
9494 @cindex ARM
9495
9496 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9497 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9498 commands that may be available.
9499
9500 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9501 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9502 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9503 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9504 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9505 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9506 @end deffn
9507
9508 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9509 @cindex disassemble
9510 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9511 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9512 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9513 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9514 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9515 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9516 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9517
9518 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9519 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9520 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9521 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9522 with a handful of exceptions.
9523 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9524 @end deffn
9525
9526 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9527 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9528 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9529 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9530 and using the MCR instruction.
9531 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9532 an ARM register.)
9533 @end deffn
9534
9535 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9536 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9537 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9538 and the MRC instruction.
9539 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9540 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9541 an ARM register.)
9542 @end deffn
9543
9544 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9545 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9546 core mode if necessary.
9547 @end deffn
9548
9549 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9550 @cindex ARM semihosting
9551 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9552
9553 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9554 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9555 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9556 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9557 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9558 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9559 @end deffn
9560
9561 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port>
9562 [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all})
9563 @cindex ARM semihosting
9564 Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
9565
9566 This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
9567 semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
9568 The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
9569 Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
9570 @end deffn
9571
9572 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9573 @cindex ARM semihosting
9574 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9575
9576 @example
9577 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9578 @end example
9579
9580 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9581 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9582 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9583 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9584 @end deffn
9585
9586 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9587 @cindex ARM semihosting
9588 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9589 status.
9590
9591 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9592 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9593 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9594 debugger.
9595 @end deffn
9596
9597 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9598 @cindex ARM semihosting
9599 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9600
9601 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9602 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9603 the value returned by the target.
9604
9605 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9606 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9607 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9608 encountering a break.
9609
9610 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9611 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9612 to the debugger.
9613 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9614 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9615 request or equivalent").
9616
9617 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9618 this option (default: disabled).
9619 @end deffn
9620
9621 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9622 @cindex ARM semihosting
9623 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9624 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9625
9626 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9627 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9628 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9629 command.
9630 @end deffn
9631
9632 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_basedir} [dir]
9633 @cindex ARM semihosting
9634 Set the base directory for semihosting I/O, either an absolute path or a path relative to OpenOCD working directory.
9635 Use "." for the current directory.
9636 @end deffn
9637
9638 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9639 @cindex ARMv4
9640 @cindex ARMv5
9641
9642 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9643 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9644 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9645 variant.
9646
9647 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9648 @cindex ARM7
9649 @cindex ARM9
9650
9651 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9652 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9653 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9654 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9655
9656 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9657 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9658 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9659 instead of breakpoints.
9660 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9661
9662 This should be
9663 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9664 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9665 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9666 @end deffn
9667
9668 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9669 @cindex DCC
9670 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9671 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9672 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9673
9674 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9675 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9676 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9677 @end deffn
9678
9679 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9680 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9681 that don't check completion of the operation.
9682 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9683
9684 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9685 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9686 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9687 @end deffn
9688
9689 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9690 @cindex ARM9
9691
9692 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9693 integer processors.
9694 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9695
9696 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9697 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9698 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9699 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9700
9701 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9702 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9703 @cindex vector_catch
9704 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9705 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9706 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9707 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9708 to those hardware vectors.
9709
9710 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9711 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9712 vector catch hardware to intercept
9713 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9714 @option{none} of them,
9715 or a list with one or more of the following:
9716 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9717 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9718 @end deffn
9719
9720 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9721 @cindex ARM920T
9722
9723 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9724 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9725 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9726 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9727 and ARM9 commands.
9728
9729 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9730 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9731 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9732 @end deffn
9733
9734 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9735 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9736 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9737 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9738 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9739 (Not all registers can be written.)
9740 @end deffn
9741
9742 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9743 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9744 @end deffn
9745
9746 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9747 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9748 @end deffn
9749
9750 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9751 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9752
9753 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9754 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9755 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9756 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9757 and ARM9 commands.
9758
9759 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9760 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9761
9762 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9763 Print information about the caches found.
9764 @end deffn
9765
9766 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9767 @cindex ARM966E
9768
9769 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9770 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9771 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9772 and ARM9 commands.
9773
9774 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9775 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9776 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9777 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9778 ARM966E-S TRM.
9779 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9780 as required for BIST support.
9781 @end deffn
9782
9783 @subsection XScale specific commands
9784 @cindex XScale
9785
9786 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9787
9788 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9789 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9790 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9791 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9792 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9793 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9794 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9795
9796 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9797 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9798 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9799 the mini-IC.
9800
9801 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9802 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9803 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9804 code layout in memory:
9805 @example
9806 _vectors:
9807 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9808 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9809 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9810 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9811 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9812 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9813 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9814 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9815 .org 0x100
9816 .long real_reset_vector
9817 .long real_ui_handler
9818 .long real_swi_handler
9819 .long real_pf_abort
9820 .long real_data_abort
9821 .long 0 /* unused */
9822 .long real_irq_handler
9823 .long real_fiq_handler
9824 @end example
9825
9826 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9827 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9828 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9829 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9830 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9831 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9832 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9833 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9834 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9835 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9836 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9837 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9838 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9839 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9840 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9841 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9842 software.
9843
9844 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9845 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9846 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9847 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9848
9849 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9850 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9851 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9852 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9853 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9854 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9855 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9856 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9857 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9858
9859 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9860 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9861
9862 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9863 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9864 @end deffn
9865
9866 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9867 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9868 @end deffn
9869
9870 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9871 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9872 @end deffn
9873
9874 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9875 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9876 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9877 @end deffn
9878
9879 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9880 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9881 @end deffn
9882
9883 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9884 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9885 @end deffn
9886
9887 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9888 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9889 @end deffn
9890
9891 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9892 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9893 @end deffn
9894
9895 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9896 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9897 @end deffn
9898
9899 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9900 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9901 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9902 and modifying how it is emptied.
9903 @end deffn
9904
9905 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9906 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9907 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9908 The image @var{type} may be one of
9909 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9910 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9911 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9912 @end deffn
9913
9914 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9915 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9916 @cindex vector_catch
9917 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9918 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9919
9920 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9921 @example
9922 0x01 Trap Reset
9923 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9924 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9925 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9926 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9927 0x20 reserved
9928 0x40 Trap IRQ
9929 0x80 Trap FIQ
9930 @end example
9931 @end deffn
9932
9933 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9934 @cindex vector_table
9935
9936 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9937 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9938 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9939 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9940 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9941
9942 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9943
9944 @end deffn
9945
9946 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9947 @cindex ARMv6
9948
9949 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9950 @cindex ARM11
9951
9952 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9953 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9954 which is enabled by default.
9955 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9956 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9957 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9958 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9959 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9960 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9961 @end deffn
9962
9963 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9964 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9965 which is enabled by default.
9966 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9967 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9968 @end deffn
9969
9970 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9971 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9972 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9973 they are disabled by default.
9974 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9975 @end deffn
9976
9977 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9978 @cindex vector_catch
9979 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9980 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9981 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9982
9983 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9984 for certain hardware events.
9985 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9986 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9987 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9988 @end deffn
9989
9990 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9991 @cindex ARMv7
9992 @cindex ARMv8
9993
9994 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9995 @cindex Cortex-A
9996
9997 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9998 display information about target caches
9999 @end deffn
10000
10001 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10002 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
10003 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
10004 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
10005 Defaults to 'off'.
10006 @end deffn
10007
10008 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
10009 Initialize core debug
10010 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10011 @end deffn
10012
10013 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
10014 Display/set the current SMP mode
10015 @end deffn
10016
10017 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
10018 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
10019 @end deffn
10020
10021 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10022 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10023 @end deffn
10024
10025 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
10026 configure l2x cache
10027 @end deffn
10028
10029 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
10030 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
10031 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
10032 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
10033 possible (4096) entries are printed.
10034 @end deffn
10035
10036 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
10037 @cindex Cortex-R
10038
10039 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
10040 Initialize core debug
10041 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10042 @end deffn
10043
10044 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10045 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048
10049 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
10050 @cindex tracing
10051 @cindex SWO
10052 @cindex SWV
10053 @cindex TPIU
10054
10055 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
10056 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
10057 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
10058 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
10059
10060 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
10061 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
10062 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
10063 which causes quite some confusion.
10064 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
10065 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
10066
10067 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
10068 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
10069 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10070
10071 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
10072 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
10073 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10074 @end deffn
10075
10076 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
10077 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
10078 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
10079 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
10080
10081 @itemize @bullet
10082 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
10083 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
10084 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
10085 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
10086
10087 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
10088 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
10089 @end itemize
10090 @end deffn
10091
10092 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
10093 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
10094 @end deffn
10095
10096 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
10097 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
10098 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
10099 at any time after the initialization, too.
10100 @end deffn
10101
10102 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
10103 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
10104 individually queried, to return its current value.
10105 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
10106 @end deffn
10107
10108 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
10109 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
10110 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
10111 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
10112
10113 @itemize @bullet
10114 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
10115 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
10116
10117 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
10118 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10119
10120 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
10121 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
10122
10123 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
10124 protocol used for trace data:
10125 @itemize @minus
10126 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
10127 data bits (default);
10128 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
10129 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
10130 @end itemize
10131
10132 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
10133 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
10134 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
10135 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
10136 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
10137 of the TPIU.
10138
10139 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
10140 the destination of the trace data:
10141 @itemize @minus
10142 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
10143 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
10144 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
10145 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
10146 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
10147 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
10148 each connected client;
10149 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
10150 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
10151 either a regular file or a named pipe.
10152 @end itemize
10153
10154 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
10155 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
10156 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
10157 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
10158
10159 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
10160 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
10161 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
10162 maximum supported rate automatically.
10163
10164 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
10165 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
10166 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
10167
10168 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
10169 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
10170 default value is @var{0}.
10171 @end itemize
10172 @end deffn
10173
10174 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
10175 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
10176 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
10177 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
10178 data.
10179 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
10180 after the @command{init}.
10181 @end deffn
10182
10183 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
10184 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
10185 @end deffn
10186
10187
10188
10189 Example usage:
10190 @enumerate
10191 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
10192 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
10193 enough to:
10194 @example
10195 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
10196 ...
10197 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
10198 ...
10199 @end example
10200 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
10201 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
10202 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
10203 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
10204 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
10205 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
10206 @example
10207 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
10208 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
10209 @end example
10210 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
10211 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
10212 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
10213 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
10214 @example
10215 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
10216 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
10217 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
10218 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
10219 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
10220 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
10221 @end example
10222 @end enumerate
10223
10224 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
10225 @cindex tracing
10226 @cindex SWO
10227 @cindex SWV
10228 @cindex ITM
10229 @cindex ETM
10230
10231 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10232 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
10233 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
10234 @end deffn
10235
10236 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10237 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
10238 @end deffn
10239
10240 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
10241 @cindex Cortex-M
10242
10243 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
10244 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
10245
10246 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
10247 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
10248 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
10249 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
10250 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
10251 the step command leaves with the core running.
10252
10253 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
10254 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
10255 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
10256 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
10257
10258 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
10259 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
10260 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
10261 does.
10262
10263 Default is @option{auto}.
10264 @end deffn
10265
10266 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10267 @cindex vector_catch
10268 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10269 for certain hardware events.
10270
10271 Parameters request interception of
10272 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
10273 @option{none} of them,
10274 or one or more of the following:
10275 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
10276 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
10277 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
10278 @option{irq_err},
10279 @option{state_err},
10280 @option{chk_err}, or
10281 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
10282 @option{reset}.
10283 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
10284 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
10285 are mapped to HardFault.
10286 UsageFault checks for
10287 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
10288 must also be explicitly enabled.
10289
10290 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
10291 @end deffn
10292
10293 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
10294 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
10295 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
10296
10297 @itemize @minus
10298 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
10299 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
10300 @end itemize
10301
10302 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
10303 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
10304 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
10305 to manually reset the peripherals.
10306 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10307
10308 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
10309 instead.
10310 @end deffn
10311
10312 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
10313 @cindex ARMv8-A
10314 @cindex aarch64
10315
10316 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
10317 Display information about target caches
10318 @end deffn
10319
10320 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
10321 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
10322 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
10323 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
10324 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
10325 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
10326 @end deffn
10327
10328 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
10329 @cindex disassemble
10330 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
10331 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
10332 @end deffn
10333
10334 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
10335 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
10336 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
10337 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
10338 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
10339 @end deffn
10340
10341 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10342 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
10343 @option{on}.
10344 @end deffn
10345
10346 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
10347 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
10348 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
10349 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
10350 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
10351 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
10352 @end deffn
10353
10354 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
10355
10356 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
10357 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
10358
10359 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
10360
10361 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
10362 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
10363 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
10364 @end deffn
10365
10366 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10367 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10368 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10369 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10370 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10371 @end deffn
10372
10373 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10374
10375 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10376 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10377 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10378 @end deffn
10379
10380 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10381
10382 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10383 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10384 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10385 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10386 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10387 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10388 can be collected.
10389
10390 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10391 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10392 tooling.
10393
10394 @quotation Issues
10395 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10396 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10397 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10398 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10399
10400 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10401 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10402 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10403 software operation on the CPU.
10404 @end quotation
10405
10406 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10407 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10408 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10409 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10410 @end deffn
10411
10412 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10413 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10414 @end deffn
10415
10416 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10417 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10418 control is disabled.
10419 @end deffn
10420
10421 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10422 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10423 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10424 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10425
10426 Supported trace formats:
10427 @itemize
10428 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10429 timing to be determined.
10430 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10431 addresses.
10432 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10433 @end itemize
10434 @end deffn
10435
10436 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10437 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10438 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10439 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10440
10441 Supported conditions:
10442 @itemize
10443 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10444 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10445 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10446 instruction matches start data and mask.
10447 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10448 instruction matches start data and mask.
10449 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10450 data and mask.
10451 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10452 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10453 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10454 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10455 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10456 @end itemize
10457 @end deffn
10458
10459 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10460 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10461 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10462 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10463
10464 Supported conditions:
10465 @itemize
10466 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10467 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10468 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10469 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10470 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10471 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10472 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10473 data and mask.
10474 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10475 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10476 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10477 @end itemize
10478 @end deffn
10479
10480 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10481 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10482
10483 Supported triggers:
10484 @itemize
10485 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10486 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10487 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10488 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10489 collection.
10490 @end itemize
10491 @end deffn
10492
10493 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10494
10495 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10496 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10497 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10498 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10499 @end deffn
10500
10501 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10502 Display trace configuration.
10503 @end deffn
10504
10505 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10506 Display trace collection status.
10507 @end deffn
10508
10509 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10510 Start manual trace collection.
10511 @end deffn
10512
10513 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10514 Stop manual trace collection.
10515 @end deffn
10516
10517 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10518 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10519 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10520 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10521 @option{size} options using DMA.
10522 @end deffn
10523
10524 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10525 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10526 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10527 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10528 @option{size} options using DMA.
10529 @end deffn
10530
10531 @section Intel Architecture
10532
10533 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10534 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10535 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10536 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10537 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10538 @itemize
10539 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10540 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10541 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10542 @end itemize
10543
10544 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10545 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10546 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10547
10548 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10549 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10550 @end deffn
10551
10552 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10553 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10554 @end deffn
10555
10556 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10557 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10558 @end deffn
10559
10560 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10561 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10562 @end deffn
10563
10564 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10565 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10566 @end deffn
10567
10568 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10569 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10570 @end deffn
10571
10572 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10573
10574 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10575 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10576
10577 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10578 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10579 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10580 @end deffn
10581 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10582 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10583
10584 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10585
10586 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10587 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10588 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10589 @end deffn
10590
10591 @subsection Registers commands
10592 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10593 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10594 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10595
10596 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10597
10598 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10599 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10600 and "timer" groups.
10601
10602 @emph{example:}
10603 @example
10604 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10605 @end example
10606
10607 @end deffn
10608
10609 @section RISC-V Architecture
10610
10611 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10612 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10613 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10614 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10615 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10616 implement version 0.11.
10617
10618 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10619
10620 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10621 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10622 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10623
10624 @subsection Vector Registers
10625
10626 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
10627 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
10628 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
10629 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
10630 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
10631 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
10632 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
10633 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
10634 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
10635
10636 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
10637 follows:
10638
10639 @example
10640 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
10641 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
10642 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
10643 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
10644 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
10645 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
10646 <union id="riscv_vector">
10647 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
10648 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
10649 <field name="w" type="words"/>
10650 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
10651 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
10652 </union>
10653 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
10654 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10655 ...
10656 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
10657 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10658 </feature>
10659 @end example
10660
10661 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10662
10663 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10664 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10665 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10666 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10667 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10668 named @code{csr<n>}.
10669
10670 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10671 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10672 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
10673 CSRs.
10674
10675 @example
10676 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
10677 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
10678
10679 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
10680 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
10681
10682 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
10683 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
10684 @end example
10685 @end deffn
10686
10687 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
10688 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10689 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10690 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
10691 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10692 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
10693 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
10694 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
10695
10696 @example
10697 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
10698 # under the name "custom16":
10699 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
10700
10701 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
10702 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
10703 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
10704
10705 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
10706 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
10707 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
10708 @end example
10709 @end deffn
10710
10711 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10712 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10713 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10714 @end deffn
10715
10716 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10717 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10718 deasserted.
10719 @end deffn
10720
10721 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10722 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10723 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10724 @end deffn
10725
10726 @deffn Command {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
10727 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
10728 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
10729
10730 Available methods are:
10731 @itemize
10732 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
10733 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
10734 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
10735 @end itemize
10736
10737 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
10738 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
10739
10740 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
10741 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
10742 @end deffn
10743
10744 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10745 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10746 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10747 on physical memory.
10748 @end deffn
10749
10750 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10751 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10752 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10753 performed on physical memory.
10754 @end deffn
10755
10756 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10757 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10758 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10759 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10760 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10761 race condition problem in your code.
10762
10763 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10764 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10765 @end deffn
10766
10767 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10768 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10769 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10770 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10771 values.
10772
10773 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10774 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10775 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10776 @end deffn
10777
10778 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10779 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10780 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10781 @end deffn
10782
10783 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10784 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10785 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10786 @end deffn
10787
10788 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10789 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10790 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10791 @end deffn
10792
10793 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10794 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10795 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10796 @end deffn
10797
10798 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10799
10800 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10801 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10802 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10803 @example
10804 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10805 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
10806 @end example
10807
10808 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10809 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10810 @end deffn
10811
10812 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10813 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10814 @end deffn
10815
10816 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10817
10818 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10819 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10820
10821 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10822 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10823 @end deffn
10824
10825 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10826 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10827 @end deffn
10828
10829 @section ARC Architecture
10830 @cindex ARC
10831
10832 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10833 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10834 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10835 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10836 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10837 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10838 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10839 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10840 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10841 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10842 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10843 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10844 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10845 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10846 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10847
10848
10849 @subsection General ARC commands
10850
10851 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10852
10853 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10854 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10855 arguments:
10856
10857 @itemize @bullet
10858
10859 @item @code{-name} name
10860 @*Name of a register.
10861
10862 @item @code{-num} number
10863 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10864
10865 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10866 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10867
10868 @end itemize
10869
10870 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10871
10872 @itemize @bullet
10873
10874 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10875 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10876 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10877 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10878 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10879 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10880
10881 @item @code{-core}
10882 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10883 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10884 spaces.
10885
10886 @item @code{-bcr}
10887 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10888 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10889 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10890 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10891 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10892
10893 @item @code{-type} type_name
10894 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10895 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10896
10897 @item @code{-g}
10898 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10899 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10900 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10901 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10902 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10903
10904 @end itemize
10905
10906 @end deffn
10907
10908 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10909 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10910 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10911 @end deffn
10912
10913 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10914 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10915 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10916 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10917 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10918 startbit endbit}.
10919 @end deffn
10920
10921 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10922 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10923 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10924 @end deffn
10925
10926 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10927 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10928 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10929 @end deffn
10930
10931 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10932
10933 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10934 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10935 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10936 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10937
10938 @end deffn
10939
10940 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10941 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10942 registers.
10943 @end deffn
10944
10945 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10946 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10947 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10948 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10949
10950 @end deffn
10951
10952 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10953 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10954 registers.
10955 @end deffn
10956
10957 @section STM8 Architecture
10958 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10959 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10960
10961 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10962 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10963
10964 @section Xtensa Architecture
10965 Xtensa processors are based on a modular, highly flexible 32-bit RISC architecture
10966 that can easily scale from a tiny, cache-less controller or task engine to a high-performance
10967 SIMD/VLIW DSP provided by Cadence.
10968 @url{https://www.cadence.com/en_US/home/tools/ip/tensilica-ip/tensilica-xtensa-controllers-and-extensible-processors.html}.
10969
10970 OpenOCD supports generic Xtensa processors implementation which can be customized by
10971 simply providing vendor-specific core configuration which controls every configurable
10972 Xtensa architecture option, e.g. number of address registers, exceptions, reduced
10973 size instructions support, memory banks configuration etc. Also OpenOCD supports SMP
10974 configurations for Xtensa processors with any number of cores and allows to configure
10975 their debug signals interconnection (so-called "break/stall networks") which control how
10976 debug signals are distributed among cores. Xtensa "break networks" are compatible with
10977 ARM's Cross Trigger Interface (CTI). For debugging code on Xtensa chips OpenOCD
10978 uses JTAG protocol. Currently OpenOCD implements several Epsressif Xtensa-based chips of
10979 @uref{https://www.espressif.com/en/products/socs, ESP32 family}.
10980
10981 @subsection General Xtensa Commands
10982
10983 @deffn {Command} {xtensa set_permissive} (0|1)
10984 By default accessing memory beyond defined regions is forbidden. This commnd controls memory access address check.
10985 When set to (1), skips access controls and address range check before read/write memory.
10986 @end deffn
10987
10988 @deffn {Command} {xtensa maskisr} (on|off)
10989 Selects whether interrupts will be disabled during stepping over single instruction. The default configuration is (off).
10990 @end deffn
10991
10992 @deffn {Command} {xtensa smpbreak} [none|breakinout|runstall] | [BreakIn] [BreakOut] [RunStallIn] [DebugModeOut]
10993 Configures debug signals connection ("break network") for currently selected core.
10994 @itemize @bullet
10995 @item @code{none} - Core's "break/stall network" is disconnected. Core is not affected by any debug
10996 signal from other cores.
10997 @item @code{breakinout} - Core's "break network" is fully connected (break inputs and outputs are enabled).
10998 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores and send such signals to them. For example when another core
10999 is stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too and vice versa.
11000 @item @code{runstall} - Core's "stall network" is fully connected (stall inputs and outputs are enabled).
11001 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11002 @item @code{BreakIn} - Core's "break-in" signal is enabled.
11003 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores. For example when another core is
11004 stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too.
11005 @item @code{BreakOut} - Core's "break-out" signal is enabled.
11006 Core will send debug break signal to other cores. For example when this core is
11007 stopped due to breakpoint hit other cores with enabled break-in signals will be stopped too.
11008 @item @code{RunStallIn} - Core's "runstall-in" signal is enabled.
11009 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11010 @item @code{DebugModeOut} - Core's "debugmode-out" signal is enabled.
11011 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11012 @end itemize
11013 @end deffn
11014
11015 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_enable} <counter_id> <select> [mask] [kernelcnt] [tracelevel]
11016 Enable and start performance counter.
11017 @itemize @bullet
11018 @item @code{counter_id} - Counter ID (0-1).
11019 @item @code{select} - Selects performance metric to be counted by the counter,
11020 e.g. 0 - CPU cycles, 2 - retired instructions.
11021 @item @code{mask} - Selects input subsets to be counted (counter will
11022 increment only once even if more than one condition corresponding to a mask bit occurs).
11023 @item @code{kernelcnt} - 0 - count events with "CINTLEVEL <= tracelevel",
11024 1 - count events with "CINTLEVEL > tracelevel".
11025 @item @code{tracelevel} - Compares this value to "CINTLEVEL" when deciding
11026 whether to count.
11027 @end itemize
11028 @end deffn
11029
11030 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_dump} (counter_id)
11031 Dump performance counter value. If no argument specified, dumps all counters.
11032 @end deffn
11033
11034 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestart} [pc <pcval>/[<maskbitcount>]] [after <n> [ins|words]]
11035 Set up and start a HW trace. Optionally set PC address range to trigger tracing stop when reached during program execution.
11036 This command also allows to specify the amount of data to capture after stop trigger activation.
11037 @itemize @bullet
11038 @item @code{pcval} - PC value which will trigger trace data collection stop.
11039 @item @code{maskbitcount} - PC value mask.
11040 @item @code{n} - Maximum number of instructions/words to capture after trace stop trigger.
11041 @end itemize
11042 @end deffn
11043
11044 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestop}
11045 Stop current trace as started by the tracestart command.
11046 @end deffn
11047
11048 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracedump} <outfile>
11049 Dump trace memory to a file.
11050 @end deffn
11051
11052 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
11053 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
11054 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
11055 @cindex tracing
11056 @cindex libdcc
11057 @cindex DCC
11058 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
11059 the target uses appropriate libraries.
11060 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
11061 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
11062
11063 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
11064 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
11065 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
11066 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
11067 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
11068 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
11069
11070 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
11071 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
11072 arrays of various size integers from the target,
11073 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
11074 The target being debugged may
11075 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
11076 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
11077 each supported by a command:
11078
11079 @itemize
11080 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
11081 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
11082 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
11083 finding out how some fault was triggered.
11084
11085 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
11086 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
11087 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
11088
11089 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
11090 and then displayed at any time.
11091 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
11092
11093 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
11094 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
11095 @end itemize
11096
11097 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
11098 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
11099 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
11100 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
11101 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
11102 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
11103 does the same thing.
11104
11105 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
11106 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
11107 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
11108 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
11109 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
11110
11111 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
11112 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
11113 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
11114 @end deffn
11115
11116 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
11117 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
11118 in the order they triggered.
11119 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
11120 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
11121 history records.
11122 @end deffn
11123
11124 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
11125 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
11126 they have been triggered.
11127 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
11128 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
11129 and associates it with that identifier.
11130
11131 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
11132 are not related except by this command.
11133 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
11134 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
11135 @end deffn
11136
11137
11138 @node JTAG Commands
11139 @chapter JTAG Commands
11140 @cindex JTAG Commands
11141 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
11142 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
11143 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
11144 may be needed to work with targets which require special
11145 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
11146
11147 To use these commands you will need to understand some
11148 of the basics of JTAG, including:
11149
11150 @itemize @bullet
11151 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
11152 devices such as a CPUs.
11153 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
11154 standard state machine (in parallel)
11155 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
11156 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
11157 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
11158 while the reading previous ones.
11159 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
11160 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
11161 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
11162 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
11163 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
11164 registers.
11165 @end itemize
11166
11167 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
11168
11169 These commands are used by developers who need to access
11170 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
11171 the order of TAP state transitions.
11172 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
11173 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
11174 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
11175 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
11176 these commands are not available.
11177
11178 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11179 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
11180 that specify the entire register.
11181 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
11182 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
11183 The return value holds the original value of each
11184 of those fields.
11185
11186 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
11187 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
11188 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
11189 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
11190 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
11191
11192 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
11193 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
11194
11195 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11196 in that state.
11197 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
11198 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11199 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11200
11201 @quotation Warning
11202 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
11203 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
11204 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
11205 data registers, which may have different lengths.
11206 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
11207 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
11208 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
11209 (by connecting a different scan chain).
11210 @end quotation
11211 @end deffn
11212
11213 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
11214 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
11215 This may be used for performance tuning.
11216
11217 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
11218 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
11219 not change with the amount of data which is written.
11220 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
11221 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
11222 instead of batching them into larger operations.
11223 @end deffn
11224
11225 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11226 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
11227 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
11228 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
11229 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
11230 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
11231
11232 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11233 in that state.
11234 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
11235 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11236 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11237
11238 @quotation Note
11239 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
11240 register values, unlike data register values.
11241 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
11242 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
11243 @end quotation
11244 @end deffn
11245
11246 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
11247 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
11248 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
11249 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
11250 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
11251 Then, in a series of single state transitions
11252 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
11253 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
11254 The final state must also be stable.
11255 @end deffn
11256
11257 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
11258 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
11259 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
11260 Instructions often need some time
11261 to execute before they take effect.
11262 @end deffn
11263
11264 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
11265 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
11266
11267 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11268 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
11269 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
11270 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
11271 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
11272 @end deffn
11273
11274 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11275 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
11276 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
11277 must also be enabled.
11278 Default is enabled.
11279 @end deffn
11280
11281 @section TAP state names
11282 @cindex TAP state names
11283
11284 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
11285 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
11286 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
11287 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
11288
11289 @itemize @bullet
11290 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
11291 acts as if TRST were pulsed
11292 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
11293 @item @b{DRSELECT}
11294 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
11295 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11296 through the data register
11297 @item @b{DREXIT1}
11298 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
11299 for update or more shifting
11300 @item @b{DREXIT2}
11301 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
11302 @item @b{IRSELECT}
11303 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
11304 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11305 through the instruction register
11306 @item @b{IREXIT1}
11307 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
11308 for update or more shifting
11309 @item @b{IREXIT2}
11310 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
11311 @end itemize
11312
11313 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
11314 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
11315 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
11316 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
11317
11318 @itemize @bullet
11319 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
11320 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
11321 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
11322 may not be as expected.
11323 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
11324 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
11325 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
11326 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
11327 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
11328 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
11329 @end itemize
11330
11331 @node Boundary Scan Commands
11332 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
11333
11334 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
11335 boundary scan based hardware testing.
11336 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
11337 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
11338
11339 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
11340 @cindex Serial Vector Format
11341 @cindex SVF
11342
11343 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
11344 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
11345 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11346 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11347
11348 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
11349 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
11350 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11351 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
11352
11353 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
11354 affect their semantics.
11355
11356 Command options:
11357 @itemize @minus
11358 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
11359 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
11360 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
11361 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
11362 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
11363 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
11364 on the real interface;
11365 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
11366 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
11367 errors.
11368 @end itemize
11369 @end deffn
11370
11371 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11372 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11373 @cindex XSVF
11374
11375 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
11376 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
11377 Xilinx devices.
11378 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11379 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11380
11381 @quotation Important
11382 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
11383 @end quotation
11384
11385 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
11386 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11387 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
11388 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
11389 that TAP.
11390 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
11391 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
11392 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
11393 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
11394 @end deffn
11395
11396 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
11397 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
11398 after building the software.
11399 You may find them useful:
11400
11401 @itemize
11402 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
11403 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
11404 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
11405 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
11406 @end itemize
11407
11408 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
11409 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
11410 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
11411 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
11412 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
11413 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
11414 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
11415
11416
11417 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
11418 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
11419 @cindex IPDBG
11420
11421 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
11422 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
11423 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
11424 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
11425 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
11426 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
11427
11428 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
11429 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
11430
11431 Command options:
11432 @itemize @bullet
11433 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
11434 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
11435 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
11436 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
11437 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
11438 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
11439 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
11440 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
11441 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
11442 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
11443 shift data through vir can be configured.
11444 @end itemize
11445 @end deffn
11446
11447 Examples:
11448 @example
11449 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
11450 @end example
11451 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
11452 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
11453
11454 @example
11455 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
11456 @end example
11457 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
11458 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
11459
11460 @node Utility Commands
11461 @chapter Utility Commands
11462 @cindex Utility Commands
11463
11464 @section RAM testing
11465 @cindex RAM testing
11466
11467 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
11468 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
11469 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
11470 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
11471 hardware problems.
11472
11473 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
11474 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
11475 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
11476 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
11477
11478 Load the memory testing functions with
11479
11480 @example
11481 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
11482 @end example
11483
11484 to get access to the following facilities:
11485
11486 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
11487 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
11488 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
11489 @end deffn
11490
11491 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
11492 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
11493 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
11494 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
11495 @end deffn
11496
11497 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
11498 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
11499 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
11500 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
11501 @end deffn
11502
11503 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
11504 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
11505 @end deffn
11506
11507 @section Firmware recovery helpers
11508 @cindex Firmware recovery
11509
11510 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
11511 devices recovery with JTAG.
11512
11513 For quickstart instructions run:
11514 @example
11515 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
11516 @end example
11517
11518 @node GDB and OpenOCD
11519 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
11520 @cindex GDB
11521 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
11522 to debug remote targets.
11523 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
11524
11525 @itemize
11526 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
11527 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
11528 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
11529 as shown in this chapter.
11530 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
11531 that also will probably need to be configured.
11532 @end itemize
11533
11534 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
11535 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
11536 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
11537 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
11538 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
11539 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
11540
11541 @section Connecting to GDB
11542 @cindex Connecting to GDB
11543 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
11544 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
11545 errors, which has since been fixed; see
11546 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
11547
11548 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
11549
11550 @enumerate
11551 @item
11552 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
11553 @example
11554 target extended-remote localhost:3333
11555 @end example
11556 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
11557
11558 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
11559 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
11560 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
11561
11562 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
11563 remote command above that becomes:
11564 @example
11565 tar ext :3333
11566 @end example
11567
11568 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
11569 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
11570 available through the command:
11571 @example
11572 target remote localhost:3333
11573 @end example
11574
11575 @item
11576 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
11577 @example
11578 target extended-remote | \
11579 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
11580 @end example
11581 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
11582 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
11583 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
11584 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
11585 @end enumerate
11586
11587 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
11588 GDB command line.
11589
11590 @section Sample GDB session startup
11591
11592 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
11593 than they do when you're debugging locally.
11594 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
11595 small ARM program.
11596 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
11597 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
11598
11599 @example
11600 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
11601 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
11602 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
11603 ...
11604 (gdb) monitor reset halt
11605 ...
11606 (gdb) load
11607 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
11608 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
11609 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
11610 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
11611 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
11612 (gdb) continue
11613 Continuing.
11614 ...
11615 @end example
11616
11617 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
11618 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
11619 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
11620 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
11621
11622 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
11623
11624 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11625 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11626 packet size and the device's memory map.
11627 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11628 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11629 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11630
11631 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11632 You may need to set those up by hand.
11633 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11634 something like:
11635
11636 @example
11637 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11638 @end example
11639
11640 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11641
11642 @example
11643 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11644 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11645 @end example
11646
11647 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11648 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11649 do not have such restrictions.
11650
11651 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11652 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11653 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11654 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11655
11656 @section Programming using GDB
11657 @cindex Programming using GDB
11658 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11659
11660 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11661 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11662 @example
11663 gdb_memory_map disable
11664 @end example
11665 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11666 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11667 working area.
11668
11669 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11670 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11671 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11672 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11673
11674 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11675 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11676
11677 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11678 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11679 @example
11680 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11681 @end example
11682
11683 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11684 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11685
11686 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11687 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11688 will be used.
11689
11690 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11691 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11692 @example
11693 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11694 @end example
11695 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11696
11697 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11698 can be used.
11699
11700 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11701 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11702 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11703
11704 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11705 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11706 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11707
11708 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11709 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11710 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11711 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11712 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11713 without any intrusion of the target process.
11714
11715 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11716 Place following command after target configuration:
11717 @example
11718 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11719 @end example
11720
11721 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11722 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11723 @example
11724 gdb_memory_map disable
11725 @end example
11726
11727 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11728 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11729 @example
11730 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11731 @end example
11732
11733 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11734 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11735
11736 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11737 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11738 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11739 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11740
11741 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11742 previously shown variables.
11743
11744 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11745 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11746 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11747 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11748 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11749
11750 @section RTOS Support
11751 @cindex RTOS Support
11752 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11753
11754 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11755 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11756
11757 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11758 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11759 GDB commands.
11760
11761 @* An example setup is below:
11762
11763 @example
11764 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11765 @end example
11766
11767 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11768
11769 Currently supported rtos's include:
11770 @itemize @bullet
11771 @item @option{eCos}
11772 @item @option{ThreadX}
11773 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11774 @item @option{linux}
11775 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11776 @item @option{embKernel}
11777 @item @option{mqx}
11778 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11779 @item @option{nuttx}
11780 @item @option{RIOT}
11781 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11782 @item @option{Zephyr}
11783 @end itemize
11784
11785 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11786 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11787
11788 @table @code
11789 @item eCos symbols
11790 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11791 @item ThreadX symbols
11792 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11793 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11794 @raggedright
11795 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11796 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11797 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11798 @end raggedright
11799 @item linux symbols
11800 init_task.
11801 @item ChibiOS symbols
11802 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11803 @item embKernel symbols
11804 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11805 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11806 @item mqx symbols
11807 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11808 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11809 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11810 @item nuttx symbols
11811 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11812 @item RIOT symbols
11813 @raggedright
11814 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11815 _tcb_name_offset.
11816 @end raggedright
11817 @item Zephyr symbols
11818 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11819 @end table
11820
11821 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11822 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11823
11824 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11825 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11826
11827 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11828 along with the project:
11829
11830 @table @code
11831 @item FreeRTOS
11832 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11833 @item uC/OS-III
11834 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11835 @end table
11836
11837 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11838 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11839 @cindex SMP
11840 @cindex RTOS
11841 @cindex hwthread
11842 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11843 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11844 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11845 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11846 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11847 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11848 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11849 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11850 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11851
11852 @node Tcl Scripting API
11853 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11854 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11855 @cindex Tcl scripts
11856 @section API rules
11857
11858 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11859 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11860 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11861
11862 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11863 pair list and lists.
11864
11865 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11866 list.
11867
11868 @example
11869 > set foo(me) Duane
11870 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11871 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11872 > set foo(duck) Donald
11873 @end example
11874
11875 If one does this:
11876
11877 @example
11878 > set foo
11879 @end example
11880
11881 The result is:
11882
11883 @example
11884 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11885 @end example
11886
11887 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11888
11889 @verbatim
11890 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11891 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11892 }
11893 @end verbatim
11894
11895 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11896 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11897
11898 @section Internal low-level Commands
11899
11900 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11901 invoke directly.
11902
11903 @itemize
11904 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11905
11906 Return information about the flash banks
11907
11908 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11909
11910 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11911 its execution. Example:
11912
11913 @example
11914 > capture "reset init"
11915 @end example
11916
11917 @end itemize
11918
11919 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11920 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11921 called "flash_banks".
11922
11923 @section Tcl RPC server
11924 @cindex RPC
11925
11926 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11927 commands and receive the results.
11928
11929 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11930 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11931 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11932 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11933 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11934
11935 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11936 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11937 @command{capture} command.
11938
11939 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11940
11941 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11942 @cindex RPC Notifications
11943
11944 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11945 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11946
11947 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11948 in the following format.
11949
11950 @verbatim
11951 type target_event event [event-name]
11952 type target_state state [state-name]
11953 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11954 @end verbatim
11955
11956 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11957 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11958 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11959 Defaults to off.
11960
11961 @end deffn
11962
11963 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11964 @cindex RPC trace output
11965
11966 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11967 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11968
11969 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11970
11971 @verbatim
11972 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11973 @end verbatim
11974
11975 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11976 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11977 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11978 Defaults to off.
11979
11980 See an example application here:
11981 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11982
11983 @end deffn
11984
11985 @node FAQ
11986 @chapter FAQ
11987 @cindex faq
11988 @enumerate
11989 @anchor{faqrtck}
11990 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11991 @cindex RTCK
11992 @cindex adaptive clocking
11993 @*
11994
11995 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11996 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11997 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11998 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11999
12000 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
12001 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
12002 for example. There are 2 basic options:
12003 @enumerate
12004 @item
12005 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
12006 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
12007 @item
12008 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
12009 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
12010 @end enumerate
12011
12012 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
12013 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
12014 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
12015 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
12016 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
12017 power).
12018
12019 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
12020 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
12021 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
12022 ARM926 scenario).
12023 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
12024 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
12025 JTAG can use a faster clock.
12026
12027 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
12028 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
12029 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
12030 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
12031
12032 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
12033
12034 In order to make use of this,
12035 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
12036 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
12037
12038 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
12039 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
12040 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
12041 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
12042 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
12043
12044 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
12045 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
12046 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
12047 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
12048
12049 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
12050 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
12051 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
12052 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
12053 with a CPLD.
12054 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
12055 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
12056 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
12057 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
12058 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
12059 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
12060
12061 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
12062
12063 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
12064
12065 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
12066 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
12067 depending on the chips on your board.
12068 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
12069 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
12070 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
12071
12072 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
12073 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
12074 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
12075
12076 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
12077 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
12078 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
12079 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
12080
12081 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
12082 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
12083 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
12084 this way.
12085
12086 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
12087 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
12088 clock rate.
12089 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
12090 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
12091 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
12092
12093 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
12094
12095 @example
12096 # Example: 1.234MHz
12097 adapter speed 1234
12098 @end example
12099
12100
12101 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
12102
12103 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
12104 around Windows filenames.
12105
12106 @example
12107 > echo \a
12108
12109 > echo @{\a@}
12110 \a
12111 > echo "\a"
12112
12113 >
12114 @end example
12115
12116
12117 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
12118
12119 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
12120 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
12121 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
12122
12123 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
12124 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
12125 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
12126
12127 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
12128 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
12129 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
12130
12131 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
12132
12133 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
12134 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
12135 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
12136 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
12137
12138 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
12139 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
12140 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
12141
12142 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
12143 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
12144
12145 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
12146 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
12147 memory read caused data abort".
12148
12149 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
12150 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
12151 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
12152 be done, feel free to add this here.
12153
12154 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
12155 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
12156 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
12157 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
12158 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
12159 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
12160 gracefully stops.
12161
12162 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
12163 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
12164 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
12165
12166 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
12167 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
12168 bytes. Painful...
12169
12170
12171 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
12172 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
12173
12174 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
12175 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
12176 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
12177 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
12178 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
12179 reset, everything else should work fine.
12180
12181 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
12182 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
12183 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
12184 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
12185
12186 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
12187 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
12188 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
12189 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
12190
12191 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
12192
12193 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
12194 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
12195 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
12196
12197 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
12198 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
12199
12200 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
12201 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
12202 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
12203 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
12204 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
12205 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
12206 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
12207 clock frequency?
12208
12209 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
12210 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
12211 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
12212 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
12213 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
12214
12215 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
12216
12217 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
12218 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
12219 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
12220 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
12221 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
12222 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
12223 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
12224
12225 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
12226
12227 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
12228 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
12229 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
12230 up DRAM and loading it with code.
12231
12232 @anchor{faqtaporder}
12233 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
12234 particular order?
12235
12236 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
12237 the same order used by the hardware.
12238
12239 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
12240 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
12241 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
12242 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
12243 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
12244 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
12245
12246 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
12247 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
12248 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
12249 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
12250
12251 @itemize @bullet
12252 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
12253 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
12254 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
12255 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
12256 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
12257 @end itemize
12258
12259 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
12260
12261 @itemize @bullet
12262 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
12263 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
12264 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
12265 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
12266 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
12267 @end itemize
12268
12269
12270 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
12271 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
12272 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
12273
12274 TODO.
12275
12276 @end enumerate
12277
12278 @node Tcl Crash Course
12279 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
12280 @cindex Tcl
12281
12282 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
12283 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
12284 how the Tcl scripts work.
12285
12286 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
12287 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
12288 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
12289 OpenOCD.
12290
12291 @section Tcl Rule #1
12292 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
12293 @enumerate
12294 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
12295 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12296 @end enumerate
12297
12298 The Tcl equal is this:
12299
12300 @enumerate
12301 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
12302 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12303 @end enumerate
12304
12305 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
12306 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
12307
12308 @section Tcl Rule #1b
12309 There is a second pair of rules.
12310 @enumerate
12311 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
12312 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
12313 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
12314 in Tcl.
12315 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12316 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
12317 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
12318 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
12319 @end enumerate
12320
12321 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
12322 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
12323 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
12324 Everything is a string}
12325
12326 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
12327 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
12328 difference is subtle.
12329 @enumerate
12330 @item Parse Time
12331 @item Evaluation Time
12332 @end enumerate
12333
12334 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
12335 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
12336 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
12337
12338 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
12339 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
12340 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
12341 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
12342
12343 @itemize @bullet
12344 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
12345 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
12346 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
12347 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
12348 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
12349 @example
12350 # bash example
12351 X=`date`
12352 echo "The Date is: $X"
12353 # Tcl example
12354 set X [date]
12355 puts "The Date is: $X"
12356 @end example
12357 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
12358 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
12359 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
12360 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
12361 is a string}
12362 @example
12363 set x "Dinner"
12364 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
12365 @end example
12366 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
12367 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
12368 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
12369 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
12370 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
12371 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
12372 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
12373 @end itemize
12374
12375 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
12376
12377 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
12378
12379 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
12380
12381 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
12382 the normal way.
12383
12384 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
12385 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
12386 line is immediately executed.
12387
12388 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
12389 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
12390
12391 @subsection Command Execution
12392
12393 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
12394 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
12395 control flow operators.
12396
12397 Commands are executed like this:
12398
12399 @enumerate
12400 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
12401 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
12402 @item Repeat until End Of File.
12403 @end enumerate
12404
12405 It sort of works like this:
12406 @example
12407 for(;;)@{
12408 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
12409
12410 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
12411
12412 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
12413 @}
12414 @end example
12415
12416 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
12417 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
12418 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
12419 of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
12420 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
12421 ``LookupCommand()''
12422
12423 @subsection The FOR command
12424
12425 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
12426 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
12427 command just like any other command.
12428
12429 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
12430 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
12431 are:
12432
12433 @enumerate 0
12434 @item The ascii text 'for'
12435 @item The start text
12436 @item The test expression
12437 @item The next text
12438 @item The body text
12439 @end enumerate
12440
12441 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
12442 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
12443 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
12444 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
12445
12446 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
12447 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
12448
12449 @example
12450 int
12451 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
12452 int *argc,
12453 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
12454 @end example
12455
12456 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
12457 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
12458 still operates in the same basic way.
12459
12460 @subsection FOR command implementation
12461
12462 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
12463 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
12464
12465 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
12466
12467 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
12468
12469 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
12470 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
12471 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
12472
12473 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
12474 expression and returns a value.
12475
12476 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
12477 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
12478 @example
12479 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
12480
12481 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
12482
12483 int
12484 MyForCommand( void *interp,
12485 int argc,
12486 char **argv )
12487 @{
12488 if( argc != 5 )@{
12489 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
12490 return ERROR;
12491 @}
12492
12493 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
12494
12495 // Execute the start statement.
12496 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
12497
12498 // Top of loop test
12499 for(;;)@{
12500 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
12501 if( i == 0 )
12502 break;
12503
12504 // Execute the body
12505 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
12506
12507 // Execute the LOOP part
12508 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
12509 @}
12510
12511 // Return no error
12512 SetResult( interp, "" );
12513 return SUCCESS;
12514 @}
12515 @end example
12516
12517 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
12518 in the same basic way.
12519
12520 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
12521
12522 @subsection source and find commands
12523 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
12524 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
12525 @*Remember the parsing rules
12526 @enumerate
12527 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
12528 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
12529 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
12530 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
12531 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
12532 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
12533 That character begins Tcl comments.)
12534 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
12535 it reads a file and executes as a script.
12536 @end enumerate
12537 @subsection format command
12538 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
12539 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
12540 @b{sprintf()}.
12541 @b{Example}
12542 @example
12543 set x 6
12544 set y 7
12545 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
12546 @end example
12547 @enumerate
12548 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12549 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12550 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12551 @* Refer to Rule #1
12552 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12553 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12554 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12555 @end enumerate
12556 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12557 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12558 @example
12559 #1 Good
12560 proc someproc @{@} @{
12561 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12562 @}
12563 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12564 #2 Good - no variables
12565 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12566 #3 Good Curly Braces
12567 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12568 puts "Time: [date]"
12569 @}
12570 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12571 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12572 @end example
12573 @enumerate
12574 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12575 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12576 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12577 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12578 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12579 command.
12580 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12581 @*There are 4 examples:
12582 @enumerate
12583 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12584 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12585 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12586 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12587 @end enumerate
12588
12589 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12590 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12591 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12592
12593 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12594 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12595 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12596 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12597 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12598 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12599 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12600 @end enumerate
12601 @subsection Global Variables
12602 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12603 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12604 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12605 @example
12606 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12607 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12608 global x #Global variable X
12609 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12610 @}
12611 @end example
12612 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12613 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12614 @example
12615 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12616 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
12617 # Create var name
12618 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12619 # Make it a global
12620 global $vn
12621 # Set it.
12622 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
12623 @}
12624 @end example
12625 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12626 @example
12627 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12628 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12629 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12630 @}
12631 @end example
12632
12633 @node License
12634 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12635 @include fdl.texi
12636
12637 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12638 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12639 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12640 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12641 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12642 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12643
12644 @printindex cp
12645
12646 @node Command and Driver Index
12647 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12648 @printindex fn
12649
12650 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)